blob: e338d555d95bd5a656d8137fe767eed69be14bbb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Fauletec554342022-09-28 14:51:49 +02006 2022/09/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100968 - 51degrees-cache-size
969 - 51degrees-data-file
970 - 51degrees-property-name-list
971 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200972 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100975 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200977 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - description
979 - deviceatlas-json-file
980 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100982 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200983 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900984 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985 - gid
986 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200987 - h1-case-adjust
988 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
990 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100991 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100992 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100993 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200994 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100996 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100997 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200998 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100999 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001000 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001001 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001003 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001005 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001007 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008 - presetenv
1009 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001010 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001011 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001023 - stats
1024 - strict-limits
1025 - uid
1026 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001027 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001028 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001029 - user
1030 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001031 - wurfl-data-file
1032 - wurfl-information-list
1033 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001038 - maxcompcpuusage
1039 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001041 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001049 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001050 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001051 - nokqueue
1052 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001053 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001054 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001056 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001077 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001078 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1079 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001095 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1096 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001098 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001099 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1100 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001101 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100111851degrees-data-file <file path>
1119 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1120 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1121
1122 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
112551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1126 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1127 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1128 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1129
1130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
113351degrees-property-separator <char>
1134 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1135 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
114051degrees-cache-size <number>
1141 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1142 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1143 By default, this cache is disabled.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148ca-base <dir>
1149 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001150 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1151 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1152 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154chroot <jail dir>
1155 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1156 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1157 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1158 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1159 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001161
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1163 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1164 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1165 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1166 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1167 set. These sets have the format
1168
1169 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1170
1171 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001172 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1174 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001175 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1176 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001177 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1178 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1179 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1180 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1181 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1182 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1183 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1184 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1185 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1186 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001188 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1189 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1190 on the machine's word size.
1191
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001192 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1194 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1195 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1196 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1197 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1198 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001199
1200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1202
1203 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1204 # first 4 CPUs
1205
1206 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1207 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1208 # word size.
1209
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001210 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001211 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001212 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1213 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1214 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1215
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1217 # and so on.
1218 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1219 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001222 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001223 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1224 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1225 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1226
1227 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1228 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1229 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1230
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001231 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1232 # and a thread range.
1233 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1234 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1235 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1236
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001237crt-base <dir>
1238 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001239 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1240 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001241
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242daemon
1243 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1244 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001245 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1246 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001248default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001249 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001250 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1251 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1252 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1253 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1254 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1255 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1256 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1257 not start with a slash ('/'):
1258 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1259 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1260
1261 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1262 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1263 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1264 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1265 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1266 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1267 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1268 each of them.
1269
1270 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1271 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1272 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1273 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1274 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1275 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1276 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1277 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1278
1279 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1280 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001281 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001282 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1283 made easily relocatable.
1284
1285 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1286 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1287 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1288 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1289 consistent across all configuration files.
1290
1291 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1292 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1293 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1294 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1295 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1296 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1297 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1298 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1299
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001300description <text>
1301 Add a text that describes the instance.
1302
1303 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1304 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1305 "<" and ">" characters.
1306
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001307deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1308 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001309 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001310
1311deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001312 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001313 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1314
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001315deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001316 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1317 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1318 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001319
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320deviceatlas-separator <char>
1321 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1322 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1323
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001324expose-experimental-directives
1325 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1326 the config file will be rejected.
1327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001328external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001329 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1330 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001331 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1332 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1333 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1334 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1335 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001338 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001339 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1340 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001341 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001342 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001344
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001345group <group name>
1346 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1347 See also "gid" and "user".
1348
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001349h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1350 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1351 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1352 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1353 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001354 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001355 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1356 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1357 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1358 specified in a proxy.
1359
1360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1367
1368 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1369 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1370 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1371 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1372 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1373
1374 Example:
1375 global
1376 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
1381h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1382 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1383 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1384 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1385 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1386 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1387 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1388 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1389 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1390
1391 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1392 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1393 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1394
1395 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1396 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1397
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001398h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1399 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1400 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1401 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1402 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1403 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1404 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1405 the keyword with "no'.
1406
1407hard-stop-after <time>
1408 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1409
1410 Arguments :
1411 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1412 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1413 SIGUSR1 signal.
1414
1415 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1416 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1417 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1418
1419 Example:
1420 global
1421 hard-stop-after 30s
1422
1423 See also: grace
1424
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001425insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001426 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001427 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1428 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1429 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1430 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1431 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1432 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1433 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001434 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001435 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1436 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1437 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1438 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1439 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1440 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1441 disable it.
1442
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001443insecure-setuid-wanted
1444 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1445 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1446 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1447 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001449 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001451 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1452 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1455 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1456 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1457 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1458
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001459issuers-chain-path <dir>
1460 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1461 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1462 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1465 "issuers-chain-path".
1466 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1467 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1468 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1469 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1470 will share the chain in memory.
1471
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001472localpeer <name>
1473 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1474 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1475 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1476 the configuration parsing.
1477
1478 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1479 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1480
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001481log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001482 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001483 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001485 configured with "log global".
1486
1487 <address> can be one of:
1488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001489 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001490 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1491 port).
1492
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001493 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1494 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1495 port).
1496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001497 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001498 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1499 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001501
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001502 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1503 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1504 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1505 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1506 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1507 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1508 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1509 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1510 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1511 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001512 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001513 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1514 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1515 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1517 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001518
1519 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1520 "fd@2", see above.
1521
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001522 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1523 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1524 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1525 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1526 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1527
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001528 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1529 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001530
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001531 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1532 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1533 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1534 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1535 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1536 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1537 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1538 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1539 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1540 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1542 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001543
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001544 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1545 one of the following :
1546
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001547 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1548 field is stripped. This is the default.
1549 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1550 rfc3164.
1551
1552 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001553 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1554
1555 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1556 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1557
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001558 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1559 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1560 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1561 designed to be used with a local log server.
1562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1564 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1565 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1566 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1567 logger consumes.
1568
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001569 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1570 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1571 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1572 used with a local log server.
1573
1574 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1575 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1576 designed to be used with a local log server.
1577
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001578 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1579 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1580 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1581 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1582
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001583 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1584 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1585 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1586 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1587 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1588
1589 <sample_size>
1590 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1591 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1592 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1593 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1594 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1595
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001596 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001598 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1599 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1600 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1601
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001602 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1603 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1604 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1605 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606
1607 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001608 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1609 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1610 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1611 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1612 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1613 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001614
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001615 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001617log-send-hostname [<string>]
1618 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1619 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1620 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1621 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1622 the logs.
1623
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001624log-tag <string>
1625 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1626 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1627 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001628 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001629
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001630lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001631 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1632 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1633 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1634 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1635 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1636 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001637 used multiple times.
1638
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001639lua-load-per-thread <file>
1640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1641 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1642 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1643 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1644 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1645 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1646 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1647 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1648 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1649 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1650 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1651 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1652 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1653 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1654 times.
1655
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001656lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1657 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1658 variable.
1659 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1660 to "path".
1661
1662 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1663 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1664 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1665 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1666 will be checked earlier.
1667
1668 As an example by specifying the following path:
1669
1670 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1671 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1672
1673 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1674 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1675 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1676 paths if that does not exist either.
1677
1678 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1679 documentation.
1680
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001681master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001682 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1683 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1684 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001685 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001686 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1687 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001688 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1689 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1690 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1691 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1692 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001693
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001694 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001695
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001696mworker-max-reloads <number>
1697 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001698 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001699 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1700 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1701 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1702
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001703nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1705 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1706 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001707 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1708 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001709 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1710 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1711 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001713nbthread <number>
1714 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001716 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1717 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1718 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1719 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001720 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1721 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1722 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1723 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1724 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1725 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1726 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001727
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001728numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001729 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001730 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1731 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1732 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1733 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1734 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1735 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1736 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1737 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001740 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1741 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1742 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1743 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001745pp2-never-send-local
1746 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1747 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1748 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1749 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1750 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1751 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1752 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1753 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1754 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1755 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1756 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1757
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001758presetenv <name> <value>
1759 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1760 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1761 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1762 and "unsetenv".
1763
1764resetenv [<name> ...]
1765 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1766 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1767 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1768 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1769 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1770 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1771 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1772 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1773
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001774stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001775 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1776 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1777 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1778 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1779 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1780 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001781 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001782 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1783 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1784 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1785 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001786
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001787server-state-base <directory>
1788 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001789 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1790 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001791
1792server-state-file <file>
1793 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1794 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1795 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1796 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1797 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1798 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1799 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1800 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001801 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1802 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001803
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001804set-dumpable
1805 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1806 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1807 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1808 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1809 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1810 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1811 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1812 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1813 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1814 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1815 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1816 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1817 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1818 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1819 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1820 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1821 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1822 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1823
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001824set-var <var-name> <expr>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1826 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1829 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1830 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1831 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1832 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1833 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
1837 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1838 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1839 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1849 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1856 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1857 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001858
1859ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1861 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1862 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1863 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1864 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001865 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1866 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1867 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001868 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001869
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001870ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1873 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1874 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1875 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1876
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001877ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1879 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1880 keyword to see available options.
1881
1882 Example:
1883 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001884 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001885
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001886ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1888 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001889 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001890 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001891 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1892 information and recommendations see e.g.
1893 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1894 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1895 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1896 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1897 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001898
1899ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1901 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1902 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1903 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1904 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001905 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1906 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1907 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1908 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1913 keyword to see available options.
1914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1928
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001929ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1930 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1931 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001932 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001933 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001934 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1935
1936 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937
1938 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1939 and won't try to remove them.
1940
1941 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1942
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001943ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001945 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1946 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1947 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
1949 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1950 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1951 optimize the startup time.
1952
1953 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1954 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1955 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1956
1957 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001958 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001959
1960 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1962 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001963
1964 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1965 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1966 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1967 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1968 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001969 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001970
1971 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001972 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001973 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1974 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1975 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1976 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1977 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001978 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001979
1980 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001982 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983 a cert bundle.
1984
1985 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1986 separately in several "crt".
1987
1988 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1989 since files are loading separately.
1990
1991 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1992 required to commit them.
1993
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001994 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001997 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1998 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1999 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002001 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2002 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2003 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
2005 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002006 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2007 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002009 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2010 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2011
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012 The default behavior is "all".
2013
2014 Example:
2015 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2016 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2017 ssl-load-extra-files none
2018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002019 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2020 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002021
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002022ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2023 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2024 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2025 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2026
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002027ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002028 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002029 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2030 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2031 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2032 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2033 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2034 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002035 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002036
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002037stats maxconn <connections>
2038 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2039 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2040
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002041stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2042 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2043 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2044 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002045 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002046 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002047
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002048 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2049 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2050 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002051
2052stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2053 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2054 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002055 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002056
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002057strict-limits
2058 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2059 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2060 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2061 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2062 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002063
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002064uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002065 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2067 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2068 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2069
2070ulimit-n <number>
2071 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2072 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2073 option.
2074
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002075unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2076 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2077
2078 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2079 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2080 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2081 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2082 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002084 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2085 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2086 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2087 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002089unsetenv [<name> ...]
2090 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2091 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2092 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2093 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2094 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2095 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2096 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2097
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098user <user name>
2099 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2100 See also "uid" and "group".
2101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002102node <name>
2103 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2104
2105 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2106 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2107 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2108 traffic.
2109
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002110wurfl-cache-size <size>
2111 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2112 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2113 - "0" : no cache is used.
2114 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002115
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002116 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2117 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002118
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002119wurfl-data-file <file path>
2120 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2121 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2127 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2128 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2129 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2130
2131 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2132
2133 Valid WURFL properties are:
2134 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2135
2136 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2137 device.
2138
2139 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2140 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2141
2142 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2143 particular web request.
2144
2145 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2146 used Libwurfl API version.
2147
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002148 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2149 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2150
2151 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2152 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2153
2154 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002156 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002157 with USE_WURFL=1.
2158
2159wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2160 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2161 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002163 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002164 with USE_WURFL=1.
2165
2166wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2167 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2168 thus before the chroot.
2169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002170 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 with USE_WURFL=1.
2172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021733.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174-----------------------
2175
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002176busy-polling
2177 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2178 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2179 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2180 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2181 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2182 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2183 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2184 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2185 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2186 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2187 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2188 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2189 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2190 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2191 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2192 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2193 "poll" pollers.
2194
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002195 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2196 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2197 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2198
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002200 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002201 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2202 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2203 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2204 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2205 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2206 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2207 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2208
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002209maxcompcpuusage <number>
2210 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2211 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2212 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2213 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2214 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2215 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2216 and from introducing high latencies.
2217
2218maxcomprate <number>
2219 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2220 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2221 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2222 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2223 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2224 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2225 default value.
2226
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227maxconn <number>
2228 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2229 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2230 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002231 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2232 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2233 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2234 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002235 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2236 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2237 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2238 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2239 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2240 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002241
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002242maxconnrate <number>
2243 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2244 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2245 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2246 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2247 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2248 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2249 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2250 fairness.
2251
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002252maxpipes <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2254 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2255 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2256 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2257 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2258 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2259
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002260maxsessrate <number>
2261 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2262 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2263 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2264 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2265 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2266 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2267 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2268 fairness.
2269
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002270maxsslconn <number>
2271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2272 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2273 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2274 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2275 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2276 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2277 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002278 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2279 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2280 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2281 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2284 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002285
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002286maxsslrate <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2288 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2289 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2290 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2291 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2292 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2293 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2294 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2295 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2296 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2297
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002298maxzlibmem <number>
2299 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2300 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2301 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002302 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2303 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2304 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2305
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002306no-memory-trimming
2307 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2308 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2309 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2310 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2311 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2312 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2313 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2314 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2315 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2316 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2317 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2318 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2319 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2320 not suffer from such a problem.
2321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322noepoll
2323 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2324 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002325 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002327noevports
2328 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2329 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2330 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2331 also "nopoll".
2332
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002333nogetaddrinfo
2334 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2335 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2336
2337nokqueue
2338 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2339 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2340 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002342nopoll
2343 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2344 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002346 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2347 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002348
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002349noreuseport
2350 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2351 command line argument "-dR".
2352
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002353nosplice
2354 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002356 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002357 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002358 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2359 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2360 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2361 "option splice-response".
2362
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002363profiling.memory { on | off }
2364 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2365 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2366 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2367 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2368 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2369 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2370 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2371 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2372 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2373
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002374profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2375 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2376 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2377 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2378 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002379 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002380 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2381 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2382 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2383 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2384
2385 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2386 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2387 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2388 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2389 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002390 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2391 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2392 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2393 CLI.
2394
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002395spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002396 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2397 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2398 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2399 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2400 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2401 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002404 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002406 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2409 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2410 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2412 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2414 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2415 openssl configuration file uses:
2416 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2417
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002418ssl-mode-async
2419 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002420 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002421 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2422 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002424 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002426
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002427tune.buffers.limit <number>
2428 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2429 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2430 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2431 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2432 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002434 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2435 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2436 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2437 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2438 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2439 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2440 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2441 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002442 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002443
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002444tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2445 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2446 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2447 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002450tune.bufsize <number>
2451 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2452 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2453 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2454 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2455 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2456 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2457 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002458 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2459 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002461 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002463 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2464 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002465
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002466tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2467 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002468
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002469tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2470 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2471 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2472 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2473 this value. The default value is 1.
2474
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002475tune.fail-alloc
2476 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2477 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2478 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2479 gracefully.
2480
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002481tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2482 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2483 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2484 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2485 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2486 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2487
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002488tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2489 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2490 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2491 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2492 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2493 change it.
2494
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002495tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2496 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002497 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2500 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2501 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2502 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2503 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2504
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002505tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2507 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2508 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2509 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2510 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002511 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002512 recommended not to change this value.
2513
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002514tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002516 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2519 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2520 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2521 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002523tune.http.cookielen <number>
2524 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2525 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2526 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2527 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2528 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2529 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2530 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2531 to change this value.
2532
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002533tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2535 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002536 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538 configuration directives too.
2539 The default value is 1024.
2540
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002541tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2542 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2543 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2544 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2545 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2546 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2547 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002548 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2549 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2550 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002551
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002552tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2553 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2554 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2555 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2556 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2557 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2558 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002559 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2560 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2561 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2562 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2563 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002564
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002565tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002566 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002567 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2568 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2569 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2570 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002573 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002574 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2575
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002576tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2577 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2578 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2579 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2580 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2581 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2582 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2583 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2584 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2585 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002587tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2588 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002589 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002590 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2591 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002593 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2594 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2595
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002596tune.lua.maxmem
2597 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2598 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2599 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2600 memory.
2601
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002602tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2603 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002604 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2605 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002608tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2609 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2610 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2611 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002614tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2615 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2616 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2617 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2618 check servers.
2619
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002620tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002621 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2622 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002623 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2624 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2625 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2626 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2627 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2628 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2629 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2630 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2631 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002632
2633tune.maxpollevents <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2635 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2636 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2637 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2638 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2639
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002640tune.maxrewrite <number>
2641 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2642 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2643 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2644 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2645 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2646 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2647 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2648 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2649 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2650 bufsize.
2651
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002652tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2653 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2654 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2655 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2656 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2657 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2658 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2659 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2660 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2661 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002662 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2663 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002664 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2665 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2666 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2667 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2668 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2669 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2670 setting this parameter to 0.
2671
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002672tune.pipesize <number>
2673 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2674 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2675 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2676 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2677 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2678 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2679
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002680tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2681 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002683 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2684 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2685 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2686 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002687 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002689tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2690 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002691 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002692 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2693 default is 20.
2694
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002695tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2696tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2697 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2698 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2699 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002700 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002702 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2703 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2704
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002705tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002707 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2708 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2709 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2710 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2711
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002712tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002714 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2715 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2716 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2717 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2718 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2719 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2720 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002721
2722tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002724 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2726 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2727 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2728 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2729 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2730 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2731 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002732
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002733tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2734tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2735 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2736 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2737 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002738 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002739 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002740 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2741 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2742 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2743 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002744 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002746tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002747 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002748 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2749 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2750 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2751 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2752 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2753 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2754 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2755 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2756 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2757 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2758 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002759
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002760tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2761 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2762 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2763 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2764 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2765
2766tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2767 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2768 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2769 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2770 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2771 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2772 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2773 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2774 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2775 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2776 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2777 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2778 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2779
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002780tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002781 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002782 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2783 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2784 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2785 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2786 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2787
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002788tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2789 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2790 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2791 performances. This is disabled by default.
2792
2793 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2794 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2795
2796 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2797
2798 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2799
2800 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2801
2802 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2803 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2804 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2805
2806 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2807 converted.
2808
2809 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2810 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2811 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2812 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2813 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2814 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2815 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002816 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2817 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002818
2819 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2820
2821 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2822 only need this line:
2823
2824 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2825
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002826tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2827 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002828 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002829 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2830 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2831 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2832 being used for too long.
2833
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002834tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2835 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2836 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2837 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2838 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2839 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2840 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2841 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2842 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2843 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2844 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002846 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002847
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002848tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2849 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2850 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2851 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2852 1000 entries.
2853
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002854tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002855tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002856tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2857tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2858tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002859 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2860 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2861 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2862 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2863 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2864 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2865 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2866 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002867
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002868 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2869 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2870 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2871 all available space is consumed.
2872 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2873 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2874 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002875
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2877 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002879 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002880 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002881 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2882
2883tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2884 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2885 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2887 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028893.3. Debugging
2890--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002892quiet
2893 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2894 line argument "-q".
2895
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002896zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002898 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2899 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2900 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2901 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2902 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2903
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029053.4. Userlists
2906--------------
2907It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2908http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2909it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2910
2911userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002912 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2914
2915group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002916 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2918 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2921 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2923 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2925 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2926 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2927 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002928
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002929 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2930 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2931 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2932 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2933 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2934 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2935 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002936 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002937 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
2939 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 userlist L1
2941 group G1 users tiger,scott
2942 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2945 user scott insecure-password elgato
2946 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 userlist L2
2949 group G1
2950 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002952 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2953 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2954 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
2956 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002957
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002958
29593.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002961It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002962several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002963instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2964values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2965automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2966In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2967using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2968tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2969reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2970Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2971that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2972each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002975 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002976 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2977
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002978bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2979 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2980 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2981
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002982disabled
2983 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2984 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2985 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2986
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002987default-bind [param*]
2988 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2989
2990default-server [param*]
2991 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2992
2993 Arguments:
2994 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2995 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002996 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2997 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2998 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2999 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003000
3001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3002
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003003enabled
3004 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3005 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003007log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003008 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3009 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3010 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3011 more details.
3012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3015 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003016 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003017 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003018 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3019 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3020 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003021
3022 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3023 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3024
3025 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003026 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3027 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3028 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003032
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003033 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3034 "server" keyword explanation below).
3035
3036server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003037 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3039 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3040 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3041 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003043 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3044 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3045 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3046 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3047 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003049 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003050 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003051 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003052 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3053 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3054 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
3056 backend mybackend
3057 mode tcp
3058 balance roundrobin
3059 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3060 stick on src
3061
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003062 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3063 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003065 Example:
3066 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003067 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3068 default-server ssl verify none
3069 server haproxy1 #local peer
3070 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3071 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003072
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003073
3074table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3075 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3076
3077 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3078 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003079 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003080 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3081 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3082 "stick-table" keyword).
3083
3084 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3085 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3086 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3087 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3088 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3089 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3090 of the stick-table name as follows:
3091
3092 peers mypeers
3093 peer A ...
3094 peer B ...
3095 table t1 ...
3096
3097 frontend fe1
3098 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3099
3100 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3101 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3102
3103 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3104 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3105 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3106 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3107 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3108 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3109 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3110
3111 peers mypeers
3112 peer A ...
3113 peer B ...
3114 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3115
3116 backend t1
3117 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3118
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003119 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003120 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3121 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3122
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031233.6. Mailers
3124------------
3125It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3126If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3127in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3128
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003129mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003130 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3131 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3132
3133mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3134 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3135
3136 Example:
3137 mailers mymailers
3138 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3139 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3140
3141 backend mybackend
3142 mode tcp
3143 balance roundrobin
3144
3145 email-alert mailers mymailers
3146 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3147 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3148
3149 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3150 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3151
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003152timeout mail <time>
3153 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3154 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3155 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3156 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3157
3158 Example:
3159 mailers mymailers
3160 timeout mail 20s
3161 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003162
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031633.7. Programs
3164-------------
3165In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3166master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3167managed the same way as the workers.
3168
3169During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3170sequence as a worker:
3171
3172 - the master is re-executed
3173 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3174 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3175 instance of the program
3176
3177During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3178
3179program <name>
3180 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3181 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3182 the management guide).
3183
3184command <command> [arguments*]
3185 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3186 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3187 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3188 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3189
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003190user <user name>
3191 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3192 See also "group".
3193
3194group <group name>
3195 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3196 See also "user".
3197
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003198option start-on-reload
3199no option start-on-reload
3200 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3201 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3202 program section.
3203
3204
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032053.8. HTTP-errors
3206----------------
3207
3208It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3209imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3210several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3211
3212http-errors <name>
3213 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3214 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3215
3216errorfile <code> <file>
3217 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3218
3219 Arguments :
3220 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003221 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003222 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003223
3224 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3225 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3226 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3227 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3228 before any chroot is performed.
3229
3230 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3231
3232 Example:
3233 http-errors website-1
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
3238 http-errors website-2
3239 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3240 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032433.9. Rings
3244----------
3245
3246It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3247servers or traces.
3248
3249ring <ringname>
3250 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3251
3252description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003253 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003254 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3255
3256format <format>
3257 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3258
3259 Arguments:
3260 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3261 one of the following :
3262
3263 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3264 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3265 designed to be used with a local log server.
3266
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003267 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3268 field is stripped. This is the default.
3269 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3270 rfc3164.
3271
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003272 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3273 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3274 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3275 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3276 is the default.
3277
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003278 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003279 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3280
3281 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3282 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3283
3284 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3285 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3286 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3287 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3288 logger consumes.
3289
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003290 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3291 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3292 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3293 with a local log server.
3294
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003295 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3296 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3297 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3298 used with a local log server.
3299
3300maxlen <length>
3301 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3302 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3303 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3304
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003305server <name> <address> [param*]
3306 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3307 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3308 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3309 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3310 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3311 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3312 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3313 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3314 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003315 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3316 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003318size <size>
3319 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3320 set to BUFSIZE.
3321
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003322timeout connect <timeout>
3323 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3324
3325 Arguments :
3326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3328 as explained at the top of this document.
3329
3330timeout server <timeout>
3331 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3336 as explained at the top of this document.
3337
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 Example:
3339 global
3340 log ring@myring local7
3341
3342 ring myring
3343 description "My local buffer"
3344 format rfc3164
3345 maxlen 1200
3346 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003347 timeout connect 5s
3348 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003350
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033513.10. Log forwarding
3352-------------------
3353
3354It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003355HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003356
3357log-forward <name>
3358 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3359
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360backlog <conns>
3361 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3362 on connections accept.
3363
3364bind <addr> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003366 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3367 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3368 syslog protocol over TCP.
3369 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3371
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003372dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003373 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3374 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3375 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3376 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003377 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003380log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3382 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3383 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003384 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003385 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3386 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3387 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003388 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389
3390 Example:
3391 global
3392 log stderr format iso local7
3393
3394 ring myring
3395 description "My local buffer"
3396 format rfc5424
3397 maxlen 1200
3398 size 32764
3399 timeout connect 5s
3400 timeout server 10s
3401 # syslog tcp server
3402 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3403
3404 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003405 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3406 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 # all messages on stderr
3408 log global
3409 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3410 log ring@myring local0
3411 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3412 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3413 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3414 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3415 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003416
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003417maxconn <conns>
3418 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3419 10 is the default.
3420
3421timeout client <timeout>
3422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003425----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003428 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3429 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3430 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3431 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003432
3433A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3434connections.
3435
3436A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3437to forward incoming connections.
3438
3439A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3440parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3441
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003442A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3443ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3444sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3445the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3446explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3447from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3448"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3449for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3450to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3451optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3452are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3453any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3454names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3455that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3456duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3457names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3458
3459Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3460settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3461of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3462profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3463timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3466'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3467case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3468
3469Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3470logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3471proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3472However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3473name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3474
3475Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3476and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3479modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3480arbitrary criteria.
3481
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003482In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3483a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003484the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485
3486 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3487 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3488 between responses and new requests.
3489
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3491 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3492 client-facing connection remains open.
3493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3495 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
3497The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3498frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3499following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003500weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003502 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003503
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003504 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3505 ----+-----+-----+----
3506 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3507 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003508 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3509 ----+-----+-----+----
3510 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003513only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3514within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3518possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003520There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003523second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003524protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3525is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3526new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003527to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003528process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3529already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3530HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3531evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3532one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3533
3534There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3535performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3536tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3537preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3538analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3539HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3540header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3541mitigate this drawback.
3542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003544method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3545set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3546in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3547is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3548to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3549above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3550to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3551"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3552frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3553frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3554as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3555upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3556on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3557the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3558upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3559frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3560remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3563--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3566limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3567they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3568limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003570option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003571and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3572with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3573specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003575
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3577------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3578acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579backlog X X X -
3580balance X - X X
3581bind - X X -
3582bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583capture cookie - X X -
3584capture request header - X X -
3585capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003586clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3587clitcpka-idle X X X -
3588clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003589compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003591declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592default-server X - X X
3593default_backend X X X -
3594description - X X X
3595disabled X X X X
3596dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003598email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003599email-alert mailers X X X X
3600email-alert myhostname X X X X
3601email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602enabled X X X X
3603errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003604errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605errorloc X X X X
3606errorloc302 X X X X
3607-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3608errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003609force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003610filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611fullconn X - X X
3612grace X X X X
3613hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003614http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003615http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003618http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003619http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003620http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003621http-check set-var X - X X
3622http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003623http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003625http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003626http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003627http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003629ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003630load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003631log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003632log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003633log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003634log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003635max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636maxconn X X X -
3637mode X X X X
3638monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639monitor-uri X X X -
3640option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3641option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3642option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3643option allbackups (*) X - X X
3644option checkcache (*) X - X X
3645option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3646option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003647option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3649option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3651option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003652option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3653option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003654option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003655option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003656option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003657option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003658option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003659option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3661option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3662option httpchk X - X X
3663option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003664option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003666option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003667option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003668option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3670option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3671option logasap (*) X X X -
3672option mysql-check X - X X
3673option nolinger (*) X X X X
3674option originalto X X X X
3675option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003676option pgsql-check X - X X
3677option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003679option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option smtpchk X - X X
3681option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3682option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3683option splice-request (*) X X X X
3684option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003685option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3687option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003689option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3691option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3692option tcpka X X X X
3693option tcplog X X X X
3694option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003695option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003696external-check command X - X X
3697external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3699rate-limit sessions X X X -
3700redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003703retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003705server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003706server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003708srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3709srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3710srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003711stats admin - X X X
3712stats auth X X X X
3713stats enable X X X X
3714stats hide-version X X X X
3715stats http-request - X X X
3716stats realm X X X X
3717stats refresh X X X X
3718stats scope X X X X
3719stats show-desc X X X X
3720stats show-legends X X X X
3721stats show-node X X X X
3722stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3724stick match - - X X
3725stick on - - X X
3726stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003727stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003728stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003729tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003730tcp-check connect X - X X
3731tcp-check expect X - X X
3732tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003733tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003734tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003735tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003736tcp-check set-var X - X X
3737tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003738tcp-request connection - X X -
3739tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003740tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003741tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003742tcp-response content - - X X
3743tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744timeout check X - X X
3745timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003746timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3749timeout http-request X X X X
3750timeout queue X - X X
3751timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003752timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003754timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003756unique-id-format X X X -
3757unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003758use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003759use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003760use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003761------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3762 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3766---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767
3768This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3769
3770
3771acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3772 Declare or complete an access list.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 no | yes | yes | yes
3775 Example:
3776 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3777 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3778 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003783backlog <conns>
3784 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | yes | yes | no
3787 Arguments :
3788 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3789 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003790 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003791
3792 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3793 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3794 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3795 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3796 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3797 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3798 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3799 backlog parameter.
3800
3801 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3802 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3803 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3804
3805 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3806
3807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003809balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments :
3814 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3815 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3816 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3817 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3818
3819 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3820 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3821 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3822 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003823 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003824 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003825 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3826 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3827 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3828 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3829 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3830 it, so that you don't worry.
3831
3832 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3833 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3834 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3835 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3836 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3837 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3838 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3839 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003841 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3842 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3843 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3844 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3845 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3846 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3847 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003848 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3849 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3850 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003851
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003853 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003854 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3855 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003856 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3858 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3859 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3860 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3861 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003862 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3863 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3864 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3865 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3866 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3867 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3870 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3871 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3872 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3873 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3874 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3875 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3876 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003877 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003879 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3880 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3881 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003883 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3884 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3885 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3886 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3887 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3888 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3889 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3890 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3891 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3892 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3893 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3894 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003896 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003897 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3898 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3899 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3900 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3901 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3902 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3903 URIs start with a leading "/".
3904
3905 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3906 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3907 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3908 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3909
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003910 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3911 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3912 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3913 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003916 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3917
3918 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003919 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3920 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3922 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3923 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3924 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003925 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003926 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3927 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003928
3929 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3930 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3931 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3932 server will receive the request.
3933
3934 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3935 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3936 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3937 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3938 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003939 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3940 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3941 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003943 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3944 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3945 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3946 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3947 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003950 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3951 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3952 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003958 random
3959 random(<draws>)
3960 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003961 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3962 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3963 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3964 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003965 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3966 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3967 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3968 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3969 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3970 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3971 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3972 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3973 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3974 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3975 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3976 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3977 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3978 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3979 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3980 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3981 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3982 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3983 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3984 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003985
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003987 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003988 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3989 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003990 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003991 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3992 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3993 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995 used instead.
3996
3997 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3998 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3999 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004000 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004001
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4003 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4004 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004007 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4008 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004010 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4011 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4012 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004014 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004015 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004016 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4017 NTLM relies on.
4018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Examples :
4020 balance roundrobin
4021 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004022 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004023 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4024 balance hdr(host)
4025 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026
4027 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4028 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004030 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4032 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4033 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004034 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
4036 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4037 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4038 defaults to 16 kB.
4039
4040 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4041 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4042
4043 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4044 Round Robin.
4045
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004046 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004047 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4048 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4049 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4050
4051 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4052
4053 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004054 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004055 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4056 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4057 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004059 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004060
4061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004062bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4063bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 no | yes | yes | no
4067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004068 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4069 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4070 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4071 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004072 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004073 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4074 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4075 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4076 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4077 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4078 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004079 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004080 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4081 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004082 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004083 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4084 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004085 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004086 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4087 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004088 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004089 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4090 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4091 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4092 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4093 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4094 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4095 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004096 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4097 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4098 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004099 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4100 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4101 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4102 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004103 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4104 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4105 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004106
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4108 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004109 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4110 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4111 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004112 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4113 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4114 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4115 the range.
4116
4117 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4118 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4119 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4120 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4121 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4122 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4123 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004124 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004125 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004127 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004128 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004129 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4130 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4131 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4132 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4133 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4134 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004136 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4137 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4138 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4139 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4142 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4143 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4144 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4145 in a frontend.
4146
4147 Example :
4148 listen http_proxy
4149 bind :80,:443
4150 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004151 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004153 listen http_https_proxy
4154 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004155 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004156
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004157 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4158 bind ipv6@:80
4159 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4160 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4161
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004162 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004163 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004164
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004165 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4166 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4167 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4168 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4169 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4170
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004171 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004172 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004173
4174
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004175bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | yes
4179 Arguments :
4180 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4181 may be used to override a default value.
4182
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004183 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004184 option may be combined with other numbers.
4185
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004186 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004187 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4188 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4189 missing from all processes.
4190
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004191 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004192 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004193 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4194 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4195 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4196 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4197 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004198 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
4200 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4201 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4202 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4203 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4204 and 'even' instances.
4205
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004206 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4207 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4208 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4209 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004211 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4212 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4213
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004214 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4215 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4216 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4217
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4219 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4220
4221 Example :
4222 listen app_ip1
4223 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004224 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 listen app_ip2
4227 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004228 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229
4230 listen management
4231 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004232 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004234 listen management
4235 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4236 bind-process 1-4
4237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004239
4240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241capture cookie <name> len <length>
4242 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | no
4245 Arguments :
4246 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4247 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4248 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4249 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4253 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4254 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4255 right if it exceeds <length>.
4256
4257 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4258 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4259 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4260 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4261
4262 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4263 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4264 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4265
4266 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4267 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4268 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004269 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4270 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4271 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
4273 Example:
4274 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4275
4276 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004277 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279
4280capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004281 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments :
4285 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004286 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4288 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4289 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4290
4291 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4292 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4293 it exceeds <length>.
4294
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004295 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4297 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4299 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4300 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4301 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004303 environments to find where the request came from.
4304
4305 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4306 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4307 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4308 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004310 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4311 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4312 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4313 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4314 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
4316 Example:
4317 capture request header Host len 15
4318 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004319 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004321 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 about logging.
4323
4324
4325capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004326 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 no | yes | yes | no
4329 Arguments :
4330 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004331 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4333 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4334 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4335
4336 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4337 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4338 it exceeds <length>.
4339
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004340 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4342 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4343 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004344 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4345 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4346 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4347 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004349 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4350 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4351 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4352 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4353 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354
4355 Example:
4356 capture response header Content-length len 9
4357 capture response header Location len 15
4358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004359 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360 about logging.
4361
4362
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004363clitcpka-cnt <count>
4364 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4365 the connection on the client side.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4370
4371 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4372 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004373 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4374 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004375
4376 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4377
4378
4379clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4380 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4381 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4382 client side.
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | no
4385 Arguments :
4386 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4387 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4388 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4389 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4390
4391 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4392 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004393 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4394 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004395
4396 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4397
4398
4399clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4400 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | no
4403 Arguments :
4404 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4405 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4406 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4407 document.
4408
4409 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4410 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004411 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4412 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004413
4414 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4415
4416
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004417compression algo <algorithm> ...
4418compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004419compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004420 Enable HTTP compression.
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004424 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4425 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004426 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
4428 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004429 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4430 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4431 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004432
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004433 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004434 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004435
4436 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4437 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4438 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4439 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4440 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004441 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004443 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4444 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4445 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4446 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4447 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4448 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4449 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004450 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004452 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004458 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004459
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004461 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4462 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4464 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4468 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004469 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004470 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4471 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004472
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004473 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004474 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4475 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004476 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004478 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4479 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4480 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4481 "multipart"
4482 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4483 header
4484 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4485 and later
4486 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4487 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004488 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004489
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004490 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004491
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004492 Examples :
4493 compression algo gzip
4494 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004496
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004497cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004498 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4499 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004500 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4506 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4507 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4508 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4509 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4510 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004511 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4513 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4514
4515 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004516 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4518 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4519 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4520 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004521 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4522 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004523 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004524 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4525 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
4527 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004528 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004530 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004531 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004532 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4535 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4536 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4537 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4538 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4539 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4540 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4543 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4544 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4545 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4546 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4547 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4548 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4549 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4550 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4553 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4554 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4557 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4558 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004559 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4560 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4561 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4562 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004563 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4564 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4565 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566
4567 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4568 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4569 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4570 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4571 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4572 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4573 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4574 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4575 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4576
4577 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4578 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4579 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4580 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4581 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4582 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4583 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4584 persistence cookie in the cache.
4585 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4586
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4588 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004589 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004590 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4591 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004592 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004593 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4594 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4595 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4596 they logout.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4600 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4601 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004603 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004604 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4605 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4606 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4607 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4608 this attribute.
4609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004610 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004611 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004612 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4613 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4614 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4615 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4616 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4617 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4620 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4621 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4622 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4623 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4624 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4625 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4626 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004627 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004628 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4629 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4630 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4631 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4632 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4633 the site.
4634
4635 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4636 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4637 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4638 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4639 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4640 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4641 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4642 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4643 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4644 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4645 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4646 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4647 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004648 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004649 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4650 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4651
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004652 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4653 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4654 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4655 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4656 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4657 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004659 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004660 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4661 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4662 repeated.
4663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4665 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4666 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4667 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Examples :
4670 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4671 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4672 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004673 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004675 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004677
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004678declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4679 Declares a capture slot.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | no
4682 Arguments:
4683 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4684
4685 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4686 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4687 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4688 for use in the response.
4689
4690 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004691 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004692 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4693
4694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695default-server [param*]
4696 Change default options for a server in a backend
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4701 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4702 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4703 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004706 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4707
4708 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711default_backend <backend>
4712 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | no
4715 Arguments :
4716 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4717
4718 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4719 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4720 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4721 will catch all undetermined requests.
4722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 Example :
4724
4725 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4726 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4727 default_backend dynamic
4728
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004729 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004732description <string>
4733 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : string
4737
4738 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4739 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4740 it describes.
4741 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4742
4743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744disabled
4745 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4751 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4752 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4753 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4754 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4755 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4756 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4757
4758 See also : "enabled"
4759
4760
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761dispatch <address>:<port>
4762 Set a default server address
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004766
4767 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4768 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4769 during start-up.
4770
4771 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4772 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4773 possible with normal servers.
4774
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004775 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004776 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4777 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4778 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4779 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4780
4781 See also : "server"
4782
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004783
4784dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4785 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4789
4790 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004792 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4793 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004795 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797enabled
4798 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
4801 Arguments : none
4802
4803 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4804 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4805
4806 See also : "disabled"
4807
4808
4809errorfile <code> <file>
4810 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | yes | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004815 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004816 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
4818 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004819 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004820 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004821 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4822 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823
4824 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4825 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4826 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4827
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004828 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4829
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004830 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4831 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4832 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4833 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4834 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4835 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4836 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4837 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4838 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4841 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4842 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004843 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004846 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 Example :
4849 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004850 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004851 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4852 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004854
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004855errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4856 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4857 section.
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | yes | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4862
4863 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004864 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004865 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4866 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4869 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4870 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4871 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4872 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004873 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004874 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4875
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004876 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4877 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004878
4879 Example :
4880 errorfiles generic
4881 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4882
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884errorloc <code> <url>
4885errorloc302 <code> <url>
4886 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889 Arguments :
4890 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893
4894 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4895 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4896 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4897 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004898 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
4900 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4901 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4902 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4903
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004904 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4907 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4908 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4909 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004910 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4912 request.
4913
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004914 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915
4916
4917errorloc303 <code> <url>
4918 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
4922 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004923 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004924 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4927 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4928 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4929 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004930 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
4932 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4933 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4934 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4935
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004936 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4939 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4940 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4941 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004942 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004944 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945
4946
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004947email-alert from <emailaddr>
4948 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004949 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | yes
4952
4953 Arguments :
4954
4955 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4956
4957 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4958 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4959
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004960 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004961 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4962 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963
4964
4965email-alert level <level>
4966 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4967 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | yes
4970
4971 Arguments :
4972
4973 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4974 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4975 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4976
4977 By default level is alert
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4980 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4981 for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004983 Alerts are sent when :
4984
4985 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4986 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4987 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4988 is notice or lower
4989 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4990 and a health check status update occurs
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4993 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004994 section 3.6 about mailers.
4995
4996
4997email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4998 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001
5002 Arguments :
5003
5004 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5010 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012
5013email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5014 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5015 mailers.
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | yes
5018
5019 Arguments :
5020
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005021 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005022
5023 By default the systems hostname is used.
5024
5025 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5026 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5027 for the proxy.
5028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005031
5032
5033email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005034 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005035 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038
5039 Arguments :
5040
5041 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5042
5043 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5044 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5045
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005046 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005047 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5048
5049
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005050force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5051 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005053 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005054
5055 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5056 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5057 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5058 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5059 marked down for maintenance operations.
5060
5061 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5062 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5063 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5064 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5065 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5066 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5067 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5068 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5069 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5070
5071 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5072 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5073 is used.
5074
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005075 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005076 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005078
5079filter <name> [param*]
5080 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | yes | yes | yes
5083 Arguments :
5084 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5085 referenced in section 9.
5086
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005087 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005088 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005089 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5090 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005091
5092 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5093 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5094
5095 Example:
5096 listen
5097 bind *:80
5098
5099 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5100 filter compression
5101 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5102
5103 compression algo gzip
5104 compression offload
5105
5106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5107
5108 See also : section 9.
5109
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111fullconn <conns>
5112 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115 Arguments :
5116 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5117 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5118
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005119 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005121 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005122 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5123 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5124 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5125 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5126 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005127 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005129 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005130 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005131 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5132 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5133 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 Example :
5136 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5137 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5138 # connections.
5139 backend dynamic
5140 fullconn 10000
5141 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5142 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5143
5144 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5145
5146
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005147grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151 Arguments :
5152 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5153 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5154 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5155
5156 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5157 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005158 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005159 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5160
5161 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5162 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5163 simplify it.
5164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005165
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005166hash-balance-factor <factor>
5167 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | no | yes
5170 Arguments :
5171 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5172 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005173 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005174
5175 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5176 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5177 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5178 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5179 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5180 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5181 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5182
5183 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5184 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5185 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5186 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5187 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5188
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005189 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5190 consistent hashing mechanism.
5191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5193
5194
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005195hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005196 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005200 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5201 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5204 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5205 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5206 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5207 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5208 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5209 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5210 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5211 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5212 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005213
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005214 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5215 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5216 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5217 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5218 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5219 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5220 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5221 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5222 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5223 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5224 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5225 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5226 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005227 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5228 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229
5230 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005232 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5234 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5235 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005236 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5237 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5238 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005239
5240 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5241 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005242 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5243 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5244 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5245 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005247 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005248 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5249 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5250 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5251 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5252 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5253 parameter.
5254
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005255 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5256 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5257 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5258 used on strings.
5259
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005260 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5261
5262 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5263 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5264 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5265 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5266 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5267 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5268 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5269 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5270 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5271 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5272 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5273 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005275 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5276 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5277 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005278
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005279 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005280
5281
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005282http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5283 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5284 ones).
5285
5286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 no | yes | yes | yes
5288
5289 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5290 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5291 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5292 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5293 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5294 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5295
5296 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5297 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5298 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5299
5300 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5301 below.
5302
5303 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5304 instance.
5305
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005306 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5307 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5308 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005310 Example:
5311 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5312 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5313 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5314
5315http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5316
5317 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5318 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5319 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5320 example, or to pass some internal information.
5321 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5322 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5323 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5324
5325http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5328 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5329
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005330http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005331
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005332 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5333 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5334 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5335 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5336 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337
5338http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5340
5341 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5342
5343 Example:
5344 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5345
5346 # applied to:
5347 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5348
5349 # outputs:
5350 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5351
5352 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5353
5354http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5356
5357 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5358
5359 Example:
5360 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5361
5362 # applied to:
5363 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5364
5365 # outputs:
5366 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5367
5368http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369
5370 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5371 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5372 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5373
5374http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5380 fallback.
5381
5382 Example:
5383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5384 http-response set-status 431
5385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5387
5388http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389
5390 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5391 inline.
5392
5393 Arguments:
5394 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5395 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5399 (request and response)
5400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5401 processing
5402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5403 processing
5404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5405 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5406 and '_'.
5407
5408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5409 followed by some converters.
5410
5411 Example:
5412 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5413
5414http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5415
5416 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5417 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5418 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5419 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5420 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005421 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 processing.
5423
5424 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5425 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005426 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 rules evaluation.
5428
5429http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5432 details about <var-name>.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5436
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005437
5438http-check comment <string>
5439 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5440 it fails.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
5443
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005444 Arguments :
5445 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5446 rule fails.
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5449 user-friendly error reporting.
5450
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 "http-check expect".
5453
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5456 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005457 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5464
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005466 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5469 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5470 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5471 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5472
5473 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5474
5475 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5476
5477 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5478
5479 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5480
5481 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5482
5483 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5484 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5485 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5486 is used.
5487
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005488 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5489 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5490 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5491 haproxy -vv.
5492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5496 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5497 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5498 different ports or with different servers.
5499
5500 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5501 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5502 the port with a "http-check connect".
5503
5504 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5505 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5506 do.
5507
5508 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5509 unset-var or comment rules.
5510
5511 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5513 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5514 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5515 option httpchk
5516
5517 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005518 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005519 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
5524 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5525
5526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529http-check disable-on-404
5530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5546 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5547 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005549 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
5551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005552http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5554 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5555 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005561 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5564 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5565 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5566 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5567 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5568 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5569 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5570 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5571 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5572 result is always conclusive.
5573
5574 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5576 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005577 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5578 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005579 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5580 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5582 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5583 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584
5585 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5586 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005587 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5588 supported :
5589 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5590 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005591 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5592 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5593 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5595 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596
5597 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5598 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5600 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5601 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5602 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5604
5605 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5607 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5608 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5609
5610 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if an error
5612 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5613 log-format string.
5614
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005616 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5617 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5619 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5620 details on the supported keywords.
5621
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005622 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5623 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5624 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5625 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5632
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005633 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5634 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5635 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5636 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5637 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5638 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5639 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640
5641 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5644 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5646 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5647
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005648 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5649 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005650 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5651 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5652 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5653 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5654 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5655 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5656 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5657 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5659 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5660 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5661 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5662 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5663 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5664 insensitive on the header names.
5665
5666 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5667 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5668 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5669 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5670 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5671 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005673 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005674 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5676 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5677 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5678 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5679 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005680 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005681 trace).
5682
5683 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5686 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5687 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5688 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5689 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005690 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005692 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5694 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5695 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5696 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5697 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005700 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5702 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5703 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5704 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5705 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5706 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5709 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5710 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5711 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5712 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005713
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5715 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005719 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005721 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5722 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5723
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005725 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726
5727 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005731 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
5736
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005737http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005738 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5739 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5741 health checks.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5746
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5748 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5749 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5750 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5751 to invent non-standard ones.
5752
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005753 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5755 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5756 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5757
5758 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5760 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005763 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005765 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5767 to add it.
5768
5769 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5771 to the log-format rules.
5772
5773 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5774 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5775 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005777 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5779 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5780 request.
5781
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5783 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005785 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5786 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5787 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5788 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005789 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5793 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005794
5795 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5796 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5797 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5798 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5799 configured request authority.
5800
5801 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5802 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005805
5806
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807http-check send-state
5808 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005813 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005814 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5816 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5817 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818
5819 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5820 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5821 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5822 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5823 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005824 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5825 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5826 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5827
5828 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5829 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5830 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5833 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5834 checked in multiple backends.
5835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005836 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5838
5839 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5840 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5841 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5842 one fails.
5843
5844 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5845 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5846 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5847
5848 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5849 server's queue.
5850
5851 Example of a header received by the application server :
5852 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5853 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005855 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5856 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005858
5859http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | no | yes | yes
5863
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005864 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5866 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5869 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5872 and '-'.
5873
5874 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5875
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005876 Examples :
5877 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005878
5879
5880http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | no | yes | yes
5884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005885 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5887 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5888 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5889 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5890 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5893 and '-'.
5894
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005895 Examples :
5896 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005899http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5900 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5901 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5902 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5903 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | yes | yes | yes
5906 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005907 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005908 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005909 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005910 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005911
5912 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5913 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5914 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5915 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5916
5917 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5918 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5919 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5920 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5921
5922 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5923 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5924 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5925 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5926 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5927 chroot is performed.
5928
5929 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5930 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5931 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5932 considered.
5933
5934 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5935 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5936 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5937 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5938 considered as a raw string.
5939
5940 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5941 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5942 "content-type".
5943
5944 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5945 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5946 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5947 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5948 evaluated as a log-format string.
5949
5950 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5951 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5952 argument to "content-type".
5953
5954 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5955 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5956 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5957 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5958
5959 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5960 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5961 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5962 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5963 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5964 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5965 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5966 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5967
5968 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5969 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5970 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5971
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005972 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5973 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5974 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5975 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5976 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5977
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005978 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5979 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5980
5981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005983 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5984
5985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 no | yes | yes | yes
5987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005988 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5989 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5990 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5991 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5992 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5995 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 Example:
6000 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6001 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6002 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 http-request allow if nagios
6005 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6006 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6007 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 Example:
6010 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6011 acl add path /addacl
6012 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6017 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 Example:
6020 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6021 acl setmap path /setmap
6022 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6027 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6030 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6036 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6037 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6038 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6039 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6040 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6041 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6046 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6047 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6048 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6049 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6050 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6051 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6052 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6057 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6063 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6064 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6065 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6066 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006067
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006068 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6069 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6070 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6071 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6072 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6073 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6074 instead.
6075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 Example:
6077 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6078 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006080http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006082 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6088 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6089 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6090 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6091 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6092 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6093 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6094 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6095 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6098 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6099 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006100 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6101
6102 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6103 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6104 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6105 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6110 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6111 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6112 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6113 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6114 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006115
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006116http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006117
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006118 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6119 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6120 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6121 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6122 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6127 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6128 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6129 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006132
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6135 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6136 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6137 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006139
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6141 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6142 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006143 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006144 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6145 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6146 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006148 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006149
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006150http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6152 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6153 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6154
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006155http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6156
6157 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6158 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6159 pointed by <resolvers>.
6160 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6161 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6162 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6163 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6164 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6165 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6166 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6167 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6168 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6169 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006170 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6171 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006172
6173 Example:
6174 resolvers mydns
6175 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6176 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6177 timeout retry 1s
6178 hold valid 10s
6179 hold nx 3s
6180 hold other 3s
6181 hold obsolete 0s
6182 accepted_payload_size 8192
6183
6184 frontend fe
6185 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006186 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006187 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6188
6189 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6190 # which mean DNS resolution error
6191 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6192
6193 default_backend be
6194
6195 backend b_503
6196 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6197 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6198 # 503 error page to end users
6199
6200 backend be
6201 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6202 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6203 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6204 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6205 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6206
6207 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6208 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6209
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006210http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6211
6212 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6213 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6214 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6215 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006216 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6217 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006218
6219 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6220
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006221http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006222http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006223http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006224http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006225http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006226http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006227http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006230
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006231 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6232
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006233 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006234 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6235 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6236 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6237 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006238
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006239 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6240 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6241 the supported backend.
6242
6243 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6244 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6245 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6246 number of segments in the path.
6247
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006248 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6249 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6250 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6251 when improperly combined.
6252
6253 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6254 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6255 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6256 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6257 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6258
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006259 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006260
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006261 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6262
6263 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6264 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6265
6266 Example:
6267 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6268
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006269 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6270
6271 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6272 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6273
6274 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6275 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6276
6277 Example:
6278 - /#foo -> /
6279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006283 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6284 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6285
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006286 Example:
6287 - /. -> /
6288 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6289 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6290 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006291
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006292 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6293 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6294
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006295 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006296 their preceding segment.
6297
6298 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6299 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6300
6301 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6302 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006303
6304 Example:
6305 - /foo/../ -> /
6306 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6307 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6308 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006309 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006310 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006311 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006312
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6314 removed as well:
6315
6316 Example:
6317 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6318 - /bar/../../ -> /
6319
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006320 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6321 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006322
6323 Example:
6324 - // -> /
6325 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6326
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006327 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6328 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6329
6330 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6331 ".", "_", and "~".
6332
6333 Example:
6334 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6335 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6336 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6337 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6338
6339 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6340 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6344 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006347 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - /%6f -> /%6F
6351 - /%zz -> /%zz
6352
6353 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6354 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6358
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006359 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006360 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6361 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6362
6363 Example:
6364 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6365 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6366 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006370 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6371 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6372 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6373 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6374 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6379 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6380 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6381 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006385
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006386 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6388 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6389 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6390 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6391 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006392
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006393 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6394 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6395 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6396 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6397 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006399 Example:
6400 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6401
6402 # applied to:
6403 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6404
6405 # outputs:
6406 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6407
6408 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6411
6412 # applied to:
6413 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 # outputs:
6416 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006417
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006418http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6420
6421 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6422 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006423 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6424 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6425 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006426
6427 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6428 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6429 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6430
6431 Example:
6432 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6433 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6434
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006435 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6436 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6437 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6438 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6439
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006440http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6444 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6445 query-string are replaced.
6446
6447 Example:
6448 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6449 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6450
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006451http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006454 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6455 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6456 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6457 against.
6458
6459 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6460 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6461 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6464 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6465 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6466 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6467 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6468 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6469 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6470 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6471 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006472 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6473 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006474
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006475 Example:
6476 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6477 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6480 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006482http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6483 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006485 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6486 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6487 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6488 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 Example:
6491 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006492
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006493 # applied to:
6494 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006495
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006496 # outputs:
6497 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006498
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6500 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6501 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006502 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6504
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6507 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006508 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006509 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006510 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511 are followed to create the response :
6512
6513 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6514 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6515 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6516 ignored.
6517
6518 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6519 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006520 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006521 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6522 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006523
6524 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6525 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6526 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006527 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006528 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529
6530 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6531 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6532 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006533 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006534 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006535 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006536
6537 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6538 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6539 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6540 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6541 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6542 as a raw content.
6543
6544 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6545 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6546 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6547 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6548 considered as a raw string.
6549
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006550 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006551 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6552 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6553 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6554
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6556 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006557 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558
6559 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6560
6561 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006562 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563 if { path /ping }
6564
6565 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6566 if { path /favicon.ico }
6567
6568 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6569 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6570 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6573http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6576 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6577 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006579http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006582 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6583 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6584 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6585 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6590 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6591 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6592 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6593 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 Arguments:
6596 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6597 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Example:
6600 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6601 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6604 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6609 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6610 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 Arguments:
6613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6614 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 Example:
6617 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6618 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6621 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6622 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6627 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6628 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6629 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6630 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 Example:
6633 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6636 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6637 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6638 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6646 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6647 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6648 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6649 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6652 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6655 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6656 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6657 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6658 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6659 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6660 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6661 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6662 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6667 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6668 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6669 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6670 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6671 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6672 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6677 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6678 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6683 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6684 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6685 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6686 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6687 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6688 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6689 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6694 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6695 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6696 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6697 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6698 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 Example :
6701 # prepend the host name before the path
6702 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006703
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006704http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6705
6706 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6707 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6708 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6713 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6714 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6715 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6716 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6721 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6722 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6723 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6724 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6725 values have higher priority.
6726 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6727 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6728 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6729 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6730 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6735 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6736 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6737 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6738 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6739 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6740 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006743
6744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6746 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6750 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6751 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006752 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6753 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006754
6755 Arguments :
6756 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6757 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006758
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006759 See also "option forwardfor".
6760
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6763 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6764
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006765 # After the masking this will track connections
6766 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6767 http-request track-sc0 src
6768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6770 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6771
6772http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6775 expression.
6776
6777 Arguments:
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6779 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6783 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6784
6785 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6786 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6787 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6788
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006789http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6791
6792 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6793 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6794 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6795 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6796 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6797
6798 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6799 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6800 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6801 results.
6802
6803 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006804 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6805 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6810 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6811 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6812 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6813 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6814 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6815 information from the request.
6816
6817 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6818
6819http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6822 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet56280382022-11-22 15:41:48 +01006823 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
6824 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
6825 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
6826 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
6827 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006828 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6829
6830http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6831
6832 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6833 inline.
6834
6835 Arguments:
6836 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6837 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6838 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6839 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6840 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6841 (request and response)
6842 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6843 processing
6844 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6845 processing
6846 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6847 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6848 and '_'.
6849
6850 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6851 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006852
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006853 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006856http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006859 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6860 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6861 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6862 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6863 agent name must be used.
6864
6865 Arguments:
6866 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6867
6868 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6869 configuration.
6870
6871http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6872
6873 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6874 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6875 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6876 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6877 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6878 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6879 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6880 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6881 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6882 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6883 action.
6884 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6885 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6886 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6887 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6888 you fully understand how it works.
6889
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006890http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6891
6892 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6893 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6894 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6895 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6896 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006897 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006898 processing.
6899
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006900 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006901 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6902 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6903 rules evaluation.
6904
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006905http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6906http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6907 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6908 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6909 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006911
6912 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6913 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6914 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006915 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6916 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6917 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6918 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6919 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6920 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006921 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006922 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6923 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6924 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006925 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006926 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6927 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6928 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6929 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6930 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006931
6932http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6934http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6935
6936 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6937 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6938 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6939 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006940 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006941 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6942 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6943 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6944 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6945 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6946 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6947 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6948
6949 Arguments :
6950 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6951 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6952 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6953 select which table entry to update the counters.
6954
6955 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6956 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6957 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6958 that table until the session ends.
6959
6960 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6961 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6962 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6963 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6964 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6965 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6966 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6967 useful information.
6968
6969 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6970 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6971 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6972 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6973 checks that make use of it.
6974
6975http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6976
6977 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006978
6979 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006980 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006981
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006982http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6983
6984 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6985 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6986 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6987 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6988 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6989 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6990
6991 Arguments :
6992 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6993
6994 Example:
6995 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6996
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006997http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6998 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6999
7000 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7001 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7002 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7003 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7004 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7005 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7006 http-buffer-request".
7007
7008 Arguments :
7009
7010 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7011 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7012
7013 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007014 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007015 bytes.
7016
7017 Example:
7018 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7019
7020 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007022http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007024 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7025 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7026 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007027
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007028
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007029http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007030 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7031
7032 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 no | yes | yes | yes
7034
7035 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7036 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7037 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7038 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7039 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7040 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007042 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7043 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007046
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007047 Example:
7048 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007052 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7053 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055 Example:
7056 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007059
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007060 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7061 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007062
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007063 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7064 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007067
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007068 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7069 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7070 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7071 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7072 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7073 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7074 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7075 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007079 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7080 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7081 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7082 example, or to pass some internal information.
7083 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7084 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7085 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7090 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007092http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007094 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007097
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007098 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7099 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7100 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7101 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7102 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7103 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7104 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007105
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007106 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7107 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7108 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7109 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7110 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007111
7112 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7113 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7114 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7115 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007119 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7120 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7121 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7122 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7123 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7124 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007126http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007127
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007128 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7129 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7130 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7131 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7132 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007134http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007135
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007136 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7137 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7138 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7139 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7140 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7141 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007142
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007143http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7144http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7145 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7146 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7147 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007149
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007150 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7151 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7152 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007153 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007154 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7155 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7156 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007157 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007158 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007162 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7163 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7164 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7165 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7166 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7167 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007169http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7170 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007171
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007172 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7173 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007175 Example:
7176 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007178 # applied to:
7179 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007181 # outputs:
7182 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007186http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7187 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007188
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007189 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007190 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007192 Example:
7193 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195 # applied to:
7196 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007197
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007198 # outputs:
7199 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007200
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007201http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7202 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7203 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007204 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007205 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7206
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007207 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007208 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7209 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007210 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007212 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007213 are followed to create the response :
7214
7215 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7216 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7217 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7218 ignored.
7219
7220 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7221 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007222 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007223 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7224 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007225
7226 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7227 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7228 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007229 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007230 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007231
7232 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7233 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7234 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007235 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007236 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007237 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007238
7239 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7240 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7241 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7242 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7243 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7244 as a raw content.
7245
7246 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7247 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7248 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7249 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7250 considered as a raw string.
7251
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007252 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7253 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7254 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7255 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7256
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007257 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7258 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007259 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007260
7261 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7262
7263 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007264 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007265 if { status eq 404 }
7266
7267 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7268 string "This is the end !" \
7269 if { status eq 500 }
7270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007271http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7272http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007274 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7275 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7276 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007277
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007278http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7279 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007280
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007281 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7282 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7283 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7284 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007285
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007286http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7287 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007288
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007289 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7290 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7291 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7292 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7293 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007294
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007295 Arguments:
7296 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007298 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7299 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007302
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007303 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7304 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7305 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007306
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007307http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7308
7309 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7310 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7311 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7312 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7313 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7314
7315http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7316
7317 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7318 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7319 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7320 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7321 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7322 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7323 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7324 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7325 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7326
7327http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7328
7329 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7330 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7331 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7332 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7333 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7334 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7335 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7336
7337http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7338
7339 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7340 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7341 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7342 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7343 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7344 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7345 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7346 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7347
7348http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7349 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7350
7351 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7352 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7353 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7354 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007355
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007357 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7358 http-response set-status 431
7359 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7360 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007363
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007364 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7365 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7366 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7367 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7368 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7369 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7370 based on some information from the request.
7371
7372 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7373
7374http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7375
7376 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7377 inline.
7378
7379 Arguments:
7380 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7381 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7382 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7383 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7384 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7385 (request and response)
7386 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7387 processing
7388 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7389 processing
7390 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7391 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7392 and '_'.
7393
7394 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7395 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007396
7397 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007401
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007402 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7403 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7404 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7405 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7406 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7407 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7408 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7409 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7410 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7411 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7412 action.
7413 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7414 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7415 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7416 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7417 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007418
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007419http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7420
7421 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7422 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7423 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7424 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7425 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007426 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007427 processing.
7428
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007429 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007430 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007431 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007432 rules evaluation.
7433
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007434http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7435http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7436http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007437
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007438 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7439 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7440 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7441 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7442 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007443 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007444
7445http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7446
7447 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7448 about <var-name>.
7449
7450 Example:
7451 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7452
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007453http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7454 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7455
7456 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7457 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7458 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7459 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7460 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7461 buffer is full.
7462
7463 Arguments :
7464
7465 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7466 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7467
7468 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007469 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007470 bytes.
7471
7472 Example:
7473 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007474
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007475http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7476 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7477
7478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7479 yes | no | yes | yes
7480
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007481 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007482 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7483 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7484 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007485
7486 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7487
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007488 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7489 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7490 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7491 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7492 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7493 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7494 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007495 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007496 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7497 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007498
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007499 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7500 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7501 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7502 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7503 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7504 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7505 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007506 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7507 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7508 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7509 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7510 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7511 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007512
7513 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7514 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7515 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7516 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7517 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7518 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7519 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7520 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007521 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007522 downsides of rare connection failures.
7523
7524 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7525 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7526 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7527 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7528 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7529 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007530 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007531 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7532 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7533 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7534 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7535 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7536
7537 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007538 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7539 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7540 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7541 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007542
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007543 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7544 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007545
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007546 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007547
7548 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7549 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7550 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7551
7552 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7553
7554
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007555http-send-name-header [<header>]
7556 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7558 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007559 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007560 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7561
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007562 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7563 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7564 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7565 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7566 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7567 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7568 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7569 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7570 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7571 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7572 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7573 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7574 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7575 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7576 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7577 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007578
7579 See also : "server"
7580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007581id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007582 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 no | yes | yes | yes
7585 Arguments : none
7586
7587 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7588 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7589 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007590
7591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007592ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7593 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007595 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007596
7597 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7598 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7599 and running).
7600
7601 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7602 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7603 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007604 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007605 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7606
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007607 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7608 "unless" condition is met.
7609
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007610 Example:
7611 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7612 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7613 ignore-persist if url_static
7614
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007615 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7616
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007617load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7618 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | no | yes | yes
7621
7622 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7623 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7624 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007625 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007626 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007627 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7628 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7629 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007631 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007632 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007633 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007634
7635 Arguments:
7636 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7637 named "server-state-file".
7638
7639 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7640 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7641 name is used as a file name.
7642
7643 none don't load any stat for this backend
7644
7645 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007646 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7647 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7648 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007649 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007650 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007651
7652 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7653 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7654
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007655 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007657 global
7658 stats socket /tmp/socket
7659 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007660
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007661 defaults
7662 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007663
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007664 backend bk
7665 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7666 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007667
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007668
7669 Then one can run :
7670
7671 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7672
7673 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7674
7675 1
7676 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7677 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7678 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7679
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007680 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007681
7682 global
7683 stats socket /tmp/socket
7684 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7685
7686 defaults
7687 load-server-state-from-file local
7688
7689 backend bk
7690 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7691 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007693
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007694 Then one can run :
7695
7696 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7697
7698 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7699
7700 1
7701 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7702 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7703 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7704
7705 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7706 "show servers state"
7707
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007708
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007709log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007710log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007711 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007712no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007713 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7715 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007716
7717 Prefix :
7718 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7719 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7720 prefix does not allow arguments.
7721
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007722 Arguments :
7723 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7724 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7725 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7726 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7727 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7728 parameter.
7729
7730 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7731 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7732
7733 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7734 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7735 standard syslog port).
7736
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007737 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7738 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7739 standard syslog port).
7740
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007741 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7742 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7743 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007744 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007745
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007746 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7747 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7748 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7749 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7750 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7751 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7752 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7753 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7754 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7755 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7756 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7757 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007758 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007759 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7760 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7761 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007762 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7763 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007764
7765 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7766 and "fd@2", see above.
7767
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007768 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7769 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7770 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7771 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7772 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7773 having the logs instantly available.
7774
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007775 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7776 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7777 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7778
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007779 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7780 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007781
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007782 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7783 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7784 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7785 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7786 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7787 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7788 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7789 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7790 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7791 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007792 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007793
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007794 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7795 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7796 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7797 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7798 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7799
7800 <sample_size>
7801 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7802 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7803 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7804 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7805 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7806
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007807 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7808 one of the following :
7809
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007810 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7811 field is stripped. This is the default.
7812 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7813 rfc3164.
7814
7815 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007816 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7817
7818 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7819 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7820
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007821 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7822 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7823 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7824 designed to be used with a local log server.
7825
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007826 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7827 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7828 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7829 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7830 systemd logger consumes.
7831
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007832 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7833 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7834 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7835 used with a local log server.
7836
7837 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7838 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7839 designed to be used with a local log server.
7840
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007841 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7842 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7843 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7844 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7845
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007846 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7847
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007848 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7849 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7850 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7851
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007852 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7853 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7854 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7855 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007856
7857 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7858 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7859 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007860 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7861 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7862 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7863 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7864 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007865
7866 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7867
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007868 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7869 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7870 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007871
7872 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7873 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7874 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7875 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7876
7877 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7878 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007879
7880 Example :
7881 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007882 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7883 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7884 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007885 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007886 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7887 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007888 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007889
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007890
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007891log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007892 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007895
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007896 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7897 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7898 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7899 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7900 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007901
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007902 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7903 "option httplog" directives.
7904
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007905log-format-sd <string>
7906 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7908 yes | yes | yes | no
7909
7910 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7911 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7912 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7913 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7914 which covers the log format string in depth.
7915
7916 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7917 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7918
7919 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7920 log format to "rfc5424".
7921
7922 Example :
7923 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7924
7925
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007926log-tag <string>
7927 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7929 yes | yes | yes | yes
7930
7931 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7932 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007933 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007934 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7935 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7936 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7937 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7938 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7939 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007940
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007941max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7942 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7943 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7944 yes | no | yes | yes
7945
7946 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7947 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7948 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7949 servers.
7950
7951 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007952 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007953 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7954 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7955 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007956 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007957 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7958 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7959 picking a different server.
7960
7961 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7962 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7963 even if they have to be queued.
7964
7965 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7966 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7967
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007968max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7969 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7970 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7971 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007972
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007973maxconn <conns>
7974 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7976 yes | yes | yes | no
7977 Arguments :
7978 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7979 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7980 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7981 closes.
7982
7983 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007984 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007985 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7986 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007987 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7988 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7989 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7990 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007991
7992 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7993 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7994 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7995
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007996 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7997 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007998
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007999 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8000
8001
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008002mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008003 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8005 yes | yes | yes | yes
8006 Arguments :
8007 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8008 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8009 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8010 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8011
8012 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8013 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8014 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8015 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8016 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8017
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008018 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8019 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8020 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008022 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008023 defaults http_instances
8024 mode http
8025
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008026
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008027monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008028 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008031 Arguments :
8032 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8033 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008034 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008035 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8036 backend and its backup.
8037
8038 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8039 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8040 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8041 servers in a list of backends.
8042
8043 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8044 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8045 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008046 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008047 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8048 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008049 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008050 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8051 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008052
8053 Example:
8054 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008056 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8057 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8058 monitor-uri /site_alive
8059 monitor fail if site_dead
8060
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008061 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008062
8063
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008064monitor-uri <uri>
8065 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8067 yes | yes | yes | no
8068 Arguments :
8069 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8070 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8071
8072 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8073 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8074 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8075 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8076 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8077 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8078 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8079 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8080
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008081 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008082 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8083 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8084 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8085 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8086 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8087 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008088
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008089 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8090 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8091 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8092 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8093
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008095 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008096 frontend www
8097 mode http
8098 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8099
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008100 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008101
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008102
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008103option abortonclose
8104no option abortonclose
8105 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8107 yes | no | yes | yes
8108 Arguments : none
8109
8110 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8111 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8112 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8113 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008114 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008115 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8116 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8117 encountered while delivering the response.
8118
8119 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8120 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8121 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8122 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8123 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8124 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008125 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008126 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008127 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008128 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8129 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8130 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8131
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008132 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8133 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008134 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8135 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8136 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8137 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8138 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8139 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008140 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008141
8142 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8143 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8144
8145 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8146
8147
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008148option accept-invalid-http-request
8149no option accept-invalid-http-request
8150 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8152 yes | yes | yes | no
8153 Arguments : none
8154
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008155 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008156 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008157 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008158 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8159 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8160 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8161 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8162 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008163 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8164 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8165 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8166 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008167 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008168 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008169 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8170 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8171 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008172
8173 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8174 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8175 been confirmed.
8176
8177 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8178 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008179 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8180 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008181 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8182
8183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8185
8186 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8187 stats socket.
8188
8189
8190option accept-invalid-http-response
8191no option accept-invalid-http-response
8192 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
8195 Arguments : none
8196
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008197 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008198 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008199 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008200 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8201 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8202 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8203 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8204 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008205 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8206 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8207 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008208
8209 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8210 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8211 been confirmed.
8212
8213 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8214 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8215 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8216 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8217
8218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8220
8221 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8222 stats socket.
8223
8224
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008225option allbackups
8226no option allbackups
8227 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | no | yes | yes
8230 Arguments : none
8231
8232 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8233 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8234 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8235 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8236 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8237 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8238 order between the backup servers anymore.
8239
8240 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8241 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8242
8243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8245
8246
8247option checkcache
8248no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008249 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8251 yes | no | yes | yes
8252 Arguments : none
8253
8254 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8255 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008256 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008257 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8258 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008259 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008260
8261 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008262 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008263 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008264 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8265 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008266 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008267 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008268 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8269 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008270 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008271 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8272 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008273 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008274 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8275 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8276 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8277 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8278 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8279 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8280 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8281 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8282 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8283
8284 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008285 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8286 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8287 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8288 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008289
8290 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8291 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008292 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008293 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008294
8295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8297
8298
8299option clitcpka
8300no option clitcpka
8301 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8303 yes | yes | yes | no
8304 Arguments : none
8305
8306 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8307 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008308 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008309 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8310
8311 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8312 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8313 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8314 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8315
8316 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8317 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8318 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8319 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8320 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8321
8322 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8323
8324 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8325 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8326 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8327
8328 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8329 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8330
8331 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8332
8333
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008334option contstats
8335 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8337 yes | yes | yes | no
8338 Arguments : none
8339
8340 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8341 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8342 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008343 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008344 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8345 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8346 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8347 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8348 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008349
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008350option disable-h2-upgrade
8351no option disable-h2-upgrade
8352 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8353 connection.
8354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8355 yes | yes | yes | no
8356 Arguments : none
8357
8358 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8359 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8360 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8361 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008362 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8363 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8364 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8365 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8366 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8367 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008368
8369 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8370 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008371
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008372option dontlog-normal
8373no option dontlog-normal
8374 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8375 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8376 yes | yes | yes | no
8377 Arguments : none
8378
8379 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8380 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8381 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8382 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8383 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8384 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8385 logged.
8386
8387 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8388 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8389 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8390
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008391 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008392 logging.
8393
8394
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008395option dontlognull
8396no option dontlognull
8397 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8399 yes | yes | yes | no
8400 Arguments : none
8401
8402 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8403 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8404 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8405 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8406 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8407 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008408 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8409 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8410 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008411
8412 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008413 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008414 would not be logged.
8415
8416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8418
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008419 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008420 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008421
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008422
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008423option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008424 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8426 yes | yes | yes | yes
8427 Arguments :
8428 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8429 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008430 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008431 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008432
8433 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8434 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8435 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8436 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8437 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8438 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8439 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008440 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8441 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8442 possible that the client has already brought one.
8443
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008444 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008445 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008446 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008447 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008448 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008449 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008450
8451 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8452 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8453 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8454 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8455 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8456 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008457 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008459 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8460 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008461 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008462 are under the control of the end-user.
8463
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008464 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008465 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8466 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008467 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8468 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8469 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008471 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008472 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8473 frontend www
8474 mode http
8475 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8476
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008477 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8478 backend www
8479 mode http
8480 option forwardfor header X-Client
8481
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008482 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008483 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008484
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008485
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008486option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8487no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8488 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8489 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8490 yes | yes | yes | no
8491 Arguments : none
8492
8493 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8494 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8495 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8496 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8497 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8498 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8499 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8500
8501 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8502 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8503 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8504 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8505 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8506 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8507 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8508 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8509 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8510 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8511
8512 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8513
8514 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8515 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8516
8517 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8518 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8519
8520
8521option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8522no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8523 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8525 yes | no | yes | yes
8526 Arguments : none
8527
8528 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8529 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8530 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8531 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8532 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8533 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8534 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8535
8536 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8537 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8538 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8539 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8540 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8541 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8542 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8543 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8544 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8545 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8546
8547 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8548
8549 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8550 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8551
8552 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8553 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8554
8555
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008556option http-buffer-request
8557no option http-buffer-request
8558 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8560 yes | yes | yes | yes
8561 Arguments : none
8562
8563 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8564 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8565 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8566 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8567 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8568 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008569 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8570 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8571 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8572 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008573
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008574 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8575 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008576
8577
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008578option http-ignore-probes
8579no option http-ignore-probes
8580 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8582 yes | yes | yes | no
8583 Arguments : none
8584
8585 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8586 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8587 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8588 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8589 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8590 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8591 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8592 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8593 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008594 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8595 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008596 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8597
8598 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8599 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8600 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8601 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8602 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8603 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8604 are often the only way to detect them.
8605
8606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8608
8609 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8610
8611
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008612option http-keep-alive
8613no option http-keep-alive
8614 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8616 yes | yes | yes | yes
8617 Arguments : none
8618
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008619 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8620 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008621 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8622 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008623 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8624 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8625 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008626
8627 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8628 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008629 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8630 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8631 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8632 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8633 situations where this option may be useful :
8634
8635 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008636 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008637
8638 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8639 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8640
8641 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8642 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8643 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8644 request.
8645
8646 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8647 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008648 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8649 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8650 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008651
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008652 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8653 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8654 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8655 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8656 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8657 not set.
8658
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008659 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8660 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8661 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008662
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008663 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008664 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008665 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008666
8667
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008668option http-no-delay
8669no option http-no-delay
8670 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | yes | yes | yes
8673 Arguments : none
8674
8675 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8676 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8677 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8678 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8679 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8680 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8681 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008682 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008683 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8684 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8685 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8686 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8687 affected.
8688
8689 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8690 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8691 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8692 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8693 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8694 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8695 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8696 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8697 latency environments.
8698
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008699 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8700
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008701
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008702option http-pretend-keepalive
8703no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008704 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707 Arguments : none
8708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008709 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008710 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8711 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8712 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008713 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008714 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8715 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8716 consider the response complete.
8717
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008718 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008719 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008720 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008721 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008722 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008723 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8724
8725 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8726 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8727 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8728 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008729 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8730 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008731 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8732
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008733 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8734 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8735 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8736 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8737 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8738 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008739
8740 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8741 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8742
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008743 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008744 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008745
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008746option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8747 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8748 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8750 yes | yes | yes | yes
8751 Arguments :
8752 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8753 with no FastCGI application configured.
8754
8755 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8756 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8757 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8758
8759 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8760 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8761
8762 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8763 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8764 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8765 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8766 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8767 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8768 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8769 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8770
8771 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8772 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008773
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008774option http-server-close
8775no option http-server-close
8776 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8778 yes | yes | yes | yes
8779 Arguments : none
8780
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008781 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8782 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8783 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8784 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008785 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8786 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8787 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8788 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8789 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8790 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8791 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8792 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8793 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8794 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8795 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008796
8797 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8798 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8799 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8800 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008801 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8802 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008803
8804 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8805 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008806 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8807 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8808 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008809
8810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8812
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008813 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8814 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008815
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008816option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008817no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008818 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8820 yes | yes | yes | no
8821 Arguments : none
8822
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008823 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008824 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8825 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8826 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8827 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8828 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008829 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008830
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008831 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008832 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008833 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8834 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8835 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008836
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008837 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8838 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8839 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8840 front of an existing proxy.
8841
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008842 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8843
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008844 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008845
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008846option httpchk
8847option httpchk <uri>
8848option httpchk <method> <uri>
8849option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008850 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8852 yes | no | yes | yes
8853 Arguments :
8854 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8855 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8856 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8857 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8858 ones.
8859
8860 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8861 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8862 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8863
8864 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8865 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8866 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008867 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868
8869 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8870 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8871 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8872 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8873 the lack of any response.
8874
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008875 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8876 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8877 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8878 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8879
8880 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8881 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8882 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008883
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008884 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8885 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008886 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008887 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008888 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008889
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008890 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8891 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8892 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8893 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8894
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008895 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008896 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8897 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8898 backend https_relay
8899 mode tcp
8900 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8901 http-check send hdr Host www
8902 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008903
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008904 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8905 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8906 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008907
8908
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008909option httpclose
8910no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008911 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8913 yes | yes | yes | yes
8914 Arguments : none
8915
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008916 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8917 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8918 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8919 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008920 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008921
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008922 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8923 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008924 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008925 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8926 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008927
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008928 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8929 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8930 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008931
8932 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8933 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008934 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8935 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8936 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008937
8938 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8939 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8940
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008941 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008942
8943
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008944option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008945 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008947 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008948 Arguments :
8949 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8950 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8951 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008952 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008953 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008954
8955 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8956 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8957 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8958 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8959 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8960 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8961 ports.
8962
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008963 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8964 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008965
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008966 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8967
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008968 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008969
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008970
8971option http_proxy
8972no option http_proxy
8973 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8975 yes | yes | yes | yes
8976 Arguments : none
8977
8978 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8979 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8980 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8981 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8982 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8983
8984 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8985 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008986 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8987 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008988
8989 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8990 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8991
8992 Example :
8993 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8994 backend direct_forward
8995 option httpclose
8996 option http_proxy
8997
8998 See also : "option httpclose"
8999
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009000
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009001option independent-streams
9002no option independent-streams
9003 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9005 yes | yes | yes | yes
9006 Arguments : none
9007
9008 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9009 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9010 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9011 receive data or not.
9012
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009013 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009014 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9015 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9016 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9017 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9018 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9019 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9020 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9021 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9022 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9023 socket buffers.
9024
9025 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9026 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9027 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9028 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9029 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9030
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009031 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009032
9033
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009034option ldap-check
9035 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9037 yes | no | yes | yes
9038 Arguments : none
9039
9040 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9041 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9042 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9043 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9044
9045 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9046 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9047
9048 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9049 configure it.
9050
9051 Example :
9052 option ldap-check
9053
9054 See also : "option httpchk"
9055
9056
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009057option external-check
9058 Use external processes for server health checks
9059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9060 yes | no | yes | yes
9061
9062 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9063 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9064 command".
9065
9066 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9067
9068 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9069
9070
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009071option idle-close-on-response
9072no option idle-close-on-response
9073 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9075 yes | yes | yes | no
9076 Arguments : none
9077
9078 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9079 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9080 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9081 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9082 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9083 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9084 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9085 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9086 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9087
9088 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9089 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9090
9091 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9092 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9093 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9094 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9095
9096 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9097 "hard-stop-after"
9098
9099
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009100option log-health-checks
9101no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009102 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 yes | no | yes | yes
9105 Arguments : none
9106
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009107 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9108 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9109 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009110
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009111 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9112 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9113 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9114 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9115 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009117 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009118 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009119
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009120 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9121 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9122 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009123
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009124
9125option log-separate-errors
9126no option log-separate-errors
9127 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9129 yes | yes | yes | no
9130 Arguments : none
9131
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009132 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009133 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9134 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9135 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9136 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9137 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9138 provides very important information.
9139
9140 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9141 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9142 error logs.
9143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009144 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009145 logging.
9146
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009147
9148option logasap
9149no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009150 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9152 yes | yes | yes | no
9153 Arguments : none
9154
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009155 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9156 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9157 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9158 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9159
9160 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9161 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9162 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9163 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9164 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009165 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009166 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9167 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9168 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9169 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009170 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009172 Examples :
9173 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9174 mode http
9175 option httplog
9176 option logasap
9177 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9178
9179 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9180 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9181 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9182 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9183
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009184 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009185 logging.
9186
9187
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009188option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009189 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9191 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009192 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009193 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9194 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009195 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9196 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009197
9198 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9199 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009200 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009201 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009202 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9203 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9204 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009205
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009206 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9207 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9208 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009209
9210 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009211 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009212 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9213 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9214 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9215 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9216 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9217 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9218 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9219
9220 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9221 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009222
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009223 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009224
9225 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9226 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9227 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9228 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009229 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009230 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009231
9232 See also: "option httpchk"
9233
9234
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009235option nolinger
9236no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009237 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9239 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009240 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009241
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009242 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009243 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9244 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9245 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9246 connections.
9247
9248 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9249 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009250 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9251 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9252 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9253 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9254 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9255 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9256 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9257 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9258 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9259 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9260 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9261 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9262 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009263
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009264 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9265 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9266 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9267 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9268 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009269
9270 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9271 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009272 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009273 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009274 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009275
9276 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9277 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9278
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009279 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9280 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009281
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009282option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9283 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9285 yes | yes | yes | yes
9286 Arguments :
9287 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9288 matching <network>
9289 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9290 header name.
9291
9292 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9293 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9294 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9295 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9296 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9297 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9298 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9299 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9300 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9301 possible that the client has already brought one.
9302
9303 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9304 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9305 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9306 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9307 header and requires different one.
9308
9309 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9310 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9311 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009312 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9313 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9314 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9315 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9316 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009317
9318 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9319 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9320 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9321 both are defined.
9322
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009323 Examples :
9324 # Original Destination address
9325 frontend www
9326 mode http
9327 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9328
9329 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9330 backend www
9331 mode http
9332 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9333
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009334 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009335
9336
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009337option persist
9338no option persist
9339 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9340 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9341 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009342 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009343
9344 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9345 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9346 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9347 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9348 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9349 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9350 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9351 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9352 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9353 redirected to another valid server.
9354
9355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9357
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009358 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009359
9360
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009361option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009362 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9364 yes | no | yes | yes
9365 Arguments :
9366 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9367 PostgreSQL server.
9368
9369 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9370 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9371 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9372 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9373
9374 See also: "option httpchk"
9375
9376
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009377option prefer-last-server
9378no option prefer-last-server
9379 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9380 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9381 yes | no | yes | yes
9382 Arguments : none
9383
9384 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009385 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009386 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9387 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009388 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009389 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009390 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009391 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9392 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009393 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009394 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009395 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9396 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9397 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009398 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9399 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9400 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009401
9402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9404
9405 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9406
9407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009408option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009409option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009410no option redispatch
9411 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9412 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9413 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009414 Arguments :
9415 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9416 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9417 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009418 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009419 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009420 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009421 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9422 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9423 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009425
9426 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9427 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9428 be able to access the service anymore.
9429
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009430 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9431 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009432
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009433 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9434 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9435 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9436 following order:
9437
9438 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9439
9440 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9441 list, or
9442
9443 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9444
9445 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9446 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9447
9448 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9449 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9450 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9451 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9452
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009453 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009454 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9455 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009456
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009457 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9458 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9459
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009460 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009461
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009462
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009463option redis-check
9464 Use redis health checks for server testing
9465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9466 yes | no | yes | yes
9467 Arguments : none
9468
9469 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9470 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9471 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9472 find the "+PONG" response message.
9473
9474 Example :
9475 option redis-check
9476
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009477 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009478
9479
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009480option smtpchk
9481option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9482 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9484 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009485 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009486 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009487 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009488 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9489
9490 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9491 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9492 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9493
9494 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9495 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9496 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9497 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9498 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9499 dead server.
9500
9501 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9502 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009503 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009504 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9505
9506 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9507 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9508 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9509 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009510 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009511
9512 Example :
9513 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9514
9515 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009518option socket-stats
9519no option socket-stats
9520
9521 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 yes | yes | yes | no
9524
9525 Arguments : none
9526
9527
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009528option splice-auto
9529no option splice-auto
9530 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9532 yes | yes | yes | yes
9533 Arguments : none
9534
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009535 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009536 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009537 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009538 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009539 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009540 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9541 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9542 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9543 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9544
9545 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9546 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9547 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9548 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9549 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9550 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9551 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9552 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9553 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9554 keyword.
9555
9556 Example :
9557 option splice-auto
9558
9559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9561
9562 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9563 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9564
9565
9566option splice-request
9567no option splice-request
9568 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9570 yes | yes | yes | yes
9571 Arguments : none
9572
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009573 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009574 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009575 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9576 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9577 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9578 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9579
9580 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9581
9582 Example :
9583 option splice-request
9584
9585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9587
9588 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9589 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9590
9591
9592option splice-response
9593no option splice-response
9594 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 yes | yes | yes | yes
9597 Arguments : none
9598
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009599 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009600 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009601 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9602 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9603 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9604 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9605
9606 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9607
9608 Example :
9609 option splice-response
9610
9611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9613
9614 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9615 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9616
9617
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009618option spop-check
9619 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 no | no | no | yes
9622 Arguments : none
9623
9624 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9625 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9626 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9627 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9628
9629 Example :
9630 option spop-check
9631
9632 See also : "option httpchk"
9633
9634
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009635option srvtcpka
9636no option srvtcpka
9637 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9639 yes | no | yes | yes
9640 Arguments : none
9641
9642 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9643 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009644 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009645 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9646
9647 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9648 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9649 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9650 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9651
9652 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9653 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9654 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9655 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9656 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9657
9658 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9659
9660 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9661 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9662 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9663
9664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9666
9667 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9668
9669
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009670option ssl-hello-chk
9671 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9673 yes | no | yes | yes
9674 Arguments : none
9675
9676 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9677 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9678 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9679 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9680 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9681 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9682 hello message.
9683
9684 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9685 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9686 messages, which is appreciable.
9687
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009688 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009689 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9690 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009691
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009692 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9693
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009694
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009695option tcp-check
9696 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9698 yes | no | yes | yes
9699
9700 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9701 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9702
9703 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9704 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9705 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9706
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009707 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009708 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9709 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9710 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9711 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9712 only.
9713
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009714 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009715 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009716 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9717 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9718 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9719
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009720 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009721 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9722 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009723 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009724 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9725 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9726 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9727 the respective protocols.
9728 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009729 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009730
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009731 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009732
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009733 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9734 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9735 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9736 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009737
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009738 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9739 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9740 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009741
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009742
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009743 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009744 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009745 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009746 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009747
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009748 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009750 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009751
9752 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9753 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009754 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009755 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009756 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009757 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009758 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009759 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009760 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9761 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009762 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009763 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9764 tcp-check expect string +OK
9765
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009767 (send many headers before analyzing)
9768 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009769 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009770 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9771 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9772 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9773 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009774 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009775
9776
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009777 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009778
9779
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009780option tcp-smart-accept
9781no option tcp-smart-accept
9782 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9784 yes | yes | yes | no
9785 Arguments : none
9786
9787 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9788 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9789 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9790 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9791 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9792 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9793
9794 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9795 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9796 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9797 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9798
9799 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9800 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9801 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009802 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009803
9804 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9805 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9806 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9807
9808 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9809 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9810 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9811
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009812 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9813
9814
9815option tcp-smart-connect
9816no option tcp-smart-connect
9817 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9819 yes | no | yes | yes
9820 Arguments : none
9821
9822 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9823 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9824 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9825 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9826 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9827
9828 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9829 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9830 complex.
9831
9832 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9833 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9834 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9835
9836 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9837 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9838
9839 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9840
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009841
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009842option tcpka
9843 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9845 yes | yes | yes | yes
9846 Arguments : none
9847
9848 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9849 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009850 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009851 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9852
9853 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9854 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9855 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9856 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9857
9858 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9859 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9860 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9861 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9862 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9863
9864 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9865
9866 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9867 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9868 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9869 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9870 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9871 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9872 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9873 backends.
9874
9875 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9876
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009877
9878option tcplog
9879 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009881 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009882 Arguments : none
9883
9884 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9885 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9886 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9887 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9888 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9889 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9890 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9891 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9892
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009893 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009895 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896
9897
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009898option transparent
9899no option transparent
9900 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009902 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009903 Arguments : none
9904
9905 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9906 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9907 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9908 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9909 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9910 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9911 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9912 appropriate server.
9913
9914 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9915 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9916
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009917 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009918 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009919
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009920
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009921external-check command <command>
9922 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9923 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9924 yes | no | yes | yes
9925
9926 Arguments :
9927 <command> is the external command to run
9928
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009929 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9930
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009931 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009932
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009933 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9934 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9935 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9936 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9937 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9938 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009939
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009940 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9941
9942 Environment variables :
9943 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9944 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9945
9946 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9947
9948 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9949
9950 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9951 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9952 for a UNIX socket).
9953
9954 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9955
9956 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9957
9958 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9959
9960 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9961
9962 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9963
9964 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9965 socket).
9966
9967 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9968 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9969
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009970 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9971
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009972 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9973 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9974 failed.
9975
9976 Example :
9977 external-check command /bin/true
9978
9979 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9980
9981
9982external-check path <path>
9983 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9985 yes | no | yes | yes
9986
9987 Arguments :
9988 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9989
9990 The default path is "".
9991
9992 Example :
9993 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9994
9995 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9996 "external-check command"
9997
9998
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009999persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010000persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010001 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10003 yes | no | yes | yes
10004 Arguments :
10005 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010006 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10007 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010008
10009 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10010 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010011 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010012 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10013 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10014 forwarded to this server.
10015
10016 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10017 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10018 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010019 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010020 a single "listen" section.
10021
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010022 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10023 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10024 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10025
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010026 Example :
10027 listen tse-farm
10028 bind :3389
10029 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10030 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10031 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10032 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10033 persist rdp-cookie
10034 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010035 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010036 balance rdp-cookie
10037 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10038 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10039
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010040 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010041
10042
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010043rate-limit sessions <rate>
10044 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10046 yes | yes | yes | no
10047 Arguments :
10048 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10049 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10050
10051 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10052 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10053 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010054 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010055 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10056 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10057
10058 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10059 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10060 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10061 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10062
10063 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10064 listen smtp
10065 mode tcp
10066 bind :25
10067 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010068 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010069
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010070 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10071 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10072 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010073
10074 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10075
10076
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010077redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10078redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10079redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010080 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10082 no | yes | yes | yes
10083
10084 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010085 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010086
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010087 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010088 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010089 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10090 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10091 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010092
10093 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10094 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10095 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10096 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10097 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010098 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10099 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10100 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10101 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010102
10103 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10104 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10105 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10106 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10107 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10108 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010109 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010110 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010111 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10112 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10113 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010114
10115 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010116 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10117 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10118 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010119 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010120 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10121 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10122 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10123 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010124
10125 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010126 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010127
10128 - "drop-query"
10129 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10130 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10131 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10132 with a location-type redirect.
10133
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010134 - "append-slash"
10135 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10136 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10137 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10138 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10139
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010140 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10141 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10142 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10143 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10144 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10145 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10146 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10147
10148 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10149 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10150 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10151 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10152 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10153 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10154 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010155
10156 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10157 acl clear dst_port 80
10158 acl secure dst_port 8080
10159 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010160 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010161 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010162 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10163
10164 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010165 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10166 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10167 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010168 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010169
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010170 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10171 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10172 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10173
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010174 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010175 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010176
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010177 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010178 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10179 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10180 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010182 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010183
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010184
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010185retries <value>
10186 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10188 yes | no | yes | yes
10189 Arguments :
10190 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10191 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10192 default value is 3.
10193
10194 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10195 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10196 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10197
10198 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010199 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10200 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010201
10202 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10203 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10204
10205 See also : "option redispatch"
10206
10207
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010208retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010209 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10210 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10211 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010212 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10213 yes | no | yes | yes
10214 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010215 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10216 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10217 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10218 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10219 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010220
10221 none never retry
10222
10223 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10224 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10225
10226 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10227 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10228 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10229 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10230 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10231 processing the request.
10232
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010233 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10234 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10235 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10236 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10237 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10238 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10239 overflow attack for example).
10240
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010241 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10242 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10243 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10244 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10245 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10246 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10247 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10248 amplify denial of service attacks.
10249
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010250 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10251 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10252 considered to be safe to retry.
10253
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010254 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10255 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10256 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10257 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10258 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010259
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010260 all-retryable-errors
10261 retry request for any error that are considered
10262 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10263 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10264 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10265
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010266 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10267 not cumulative.
10268
10269 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10270 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10271 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10272 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10273
10274 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10275 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10276 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10277 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10278 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10279 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10280 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10281 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10282 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10283 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10284 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10285 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10286
10287 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10288 should not use this directive.
10289
10290 The default is "conn-failure".
10291
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010292 Example:
10293 retry-on 503 504
10294
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010295 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10296
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010297server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010298 Declare a server in a backend
10299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10300 no | no | yes | yes
10301 Arguments :
10302 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010303 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010304 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010305
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010306 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10307 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10308 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10309 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010310 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10311 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010312 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010313 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10314 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010315 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10316 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10317 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10318 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10319 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10320 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10321 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010322 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010323 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10324 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10325 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10326 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10327 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10328 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010329 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10330 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010331 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10332 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010333
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010334 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010335 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10336 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10337 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10338 adding this value to the client's port.
10339
10340 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10341 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010342 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010343
10344 Examples :
10345 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10346 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010347 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010348 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10349 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10350 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010351
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010352 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10353 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10354 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10355 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10356 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10357
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010358 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10359 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010360
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010361server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010362 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010363 this backend.
10364 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10365 no | no | yes | yes
10366
10367 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10368 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10369 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10370 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10371 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010372
10373 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10374 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10375
10376 global
10377 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10378
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010379 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010380 load-server-state-from-file
10381
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010382 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010383 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010384
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010385server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10386 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10387 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10389 no | no | yes | yes
10390
10391 Arguments:
10392 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10393
10394 <num | range>
10395 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10396 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10397 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10398 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10399
10400 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10401
10402 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10403
10404 <params*>
10405 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10406 keyword.
10407
10408 Examples:
10409 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10410 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10411 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10412
10413 # or
10414 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10415
10416 # would be equivalent to:
10417 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10418 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10419 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10420
10421
10422
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010423source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010424source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010425source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010426 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10428 yes | no | yes | yes
10429 Arguments :
10430 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10431 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010432
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010433 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010434 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10435 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10436 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10437 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10438 supported prefixes are :
10439 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10440 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10441 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010442 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010443 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10444 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010445
10446 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10447 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010448 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10449 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10450 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010451
10452 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10453 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10454 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10455 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10456 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10457 <addr>.
10458
10459 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10460 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10461 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10462 port.
10463
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010464 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10465 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10466 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10467 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010468 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010469 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10470 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10471 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10472 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10473 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10474 HTTP header.
10475
10476 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10477 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010478 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010479 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10480 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10481 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10482 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10483 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10484 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10485 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10486
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010487 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10488 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10489 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10490 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10491 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10492 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10493
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010494 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10495 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10496 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10497 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10498
10499 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10500 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10501 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10502 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10503 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10504 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10505
10506 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10507 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10508 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10509 there are two methods :
10510
10511 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10512 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10513 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10514 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10515 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10516 of the client ranges may be used.
10517
10518 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10519 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10520 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10521 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10522 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10523 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10524 same session.
10525
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010526 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10527 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10528 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010529 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010530
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010531 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10532
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010533 Examples :
10534 backend private
10535 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10536 source 192.168.1.200
10537
10538 backend transparent_ssl1
10539 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10540 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10541
10542 backend transparent_ssl2
10543 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10544 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10545 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10546
10547 backend transparent_ssl3
10548 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10549 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10550 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10551
10552 backend transparent_smtp
10553 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10554 # with Tproxy version 4.
10555 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10556
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010557 backend transparent_http
10558 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10559 # proxy.
10560 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010562 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010563 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10564
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010565
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010566srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10567 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10568 the connection on the server side.
10569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10570 yes | no | yes | yes
10571 Arguments :
10572 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10573
10574 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10575 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010576 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10577 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010578
10579 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10580
10581
10582srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10583 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10584 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10585 server side.
10586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10587 yes | no | yes | yes
10588 Arguments :
10589 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10590 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10591 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10592 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10593
10594 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10595 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010596 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10597 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010598
10599 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10600
10601
10602srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10603 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10605 yes | no | yes | yes
10606 Arguments :
10607 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10608 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10609 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10610 document.
10611
10612 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10613 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010614 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10615 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010616
10617 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10618
10619
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010620stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10621 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010623 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010624
10625 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10626 matched.
10627
10628 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10629 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10630
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010631 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10632 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010633 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010634
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010635 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10636 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10637 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10638 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010639
10640 Example :
10641 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10642 backend stats_localhost
10643 stats enable
10644 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10645
10646 Example :
10647 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10648 backend stats_auth
10649 stats enable
10650 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10651 stats admin if TRUE
10652
10653 Example :
10654 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10655 userlist stats-auth
10656 group admin users admin
10657 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10658 group readonly users haproxy
10659 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10660
10661 backend stats_auth
10662 stats enable
10663 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10664 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10665 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10666 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10667
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010668 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10669 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10670 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010671
10672
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010673stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10674 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010676 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010677 Arguments :
10678 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10679
10680 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10681
10682 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10683 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10684 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10685 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10686 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10687 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10688
10689 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10690 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10691 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010692 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010693
10694 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10695 report using "stats scope".
10696
10697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10699 unobvious parameters.
10700
10701 Example :
10702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10703 backend public_www
10704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10705 stats enable
10706 stats hide-version
10707 stats scope .
10708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10712
10713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10714 backend private_monitoring
10715 stats enable
10716 stats uri /admin?stats
10717 stats refresh 5s
10718
10719 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10720
10721
10722stats enable
10723 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010726 Arguments : none
10727
10728 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10729 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10730 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10731 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10732 - stats auth : no authentication
10733 - stats scope : no restriction
10734
10735 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10736 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10737 unobvious parameters.
10738
10739 Example :
10740 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10741 backend public_www
10742 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10743 stats enable
10744 stats hide-version
10745 stats scope .
10746 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010747 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010748 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10749 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10750
10751 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10752 backend private_monitoring
10753 stats enable
10754 stats uri /admin?stats
10755 stats refresh 5s
10756
10757 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10758
10759
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010760stats hide-version
10761 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010763 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010764 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010765
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010766 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10767 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10768 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10769 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10770 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10771 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010773 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10774 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10775 unobvious parameters.
10776
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010777 Example :
10778 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10779 backend public_www
10780 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010781 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010782 stats hide-version
10783 stats scope .
10784 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010785 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010786 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10787 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010788
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10790 backend private_monitoring
10791 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010792 stats uri /admin?stats
10793 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010794
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010795 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010796
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010797
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010798stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10799 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10800 Access control for statistics
10801
10802 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10803 no | no | yes | yes
10804
10805 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10806 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10807 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10808 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10809 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10810 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10811
10812 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10813 instance.
10814
10815 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10816 about ACL usage.
10817
10818
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010819stats realm <realm>
10820 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010822 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010823 Arguments :
10824 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10825 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10826 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10827
10828 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10829 using a backslash ('\').
10830
10831 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10832 only related to authentication.
10833
10834 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10835 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10836 unobvious parameters.
10837
10838 Example :
10839 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10840 backend public_www
10841 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10842 stats enable
10843 stats hide-version
10844 stats scope .
10845 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010846 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010847 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10848 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10849
10850 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10851 backend private_monitoring
10852 stats enable
10853 stats uri /admin?stats
10854 stats refresh 5s
10855
10856 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10857
10858
10859stats refresh <delay>
10860 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10861 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010862 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010863 Arguments :
10864 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10865 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10866 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10867 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10868 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10869 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10870
10871 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10872 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10873 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010874 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010875
10876 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10877 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10878 unobvious parameters.
10879
10880 Example :
10881 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10882 backend public_www
10883 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10884 stats enable
10885 stats hide-version
10886 stats scope .
10887 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010889 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10890 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10891
10892 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10893 backend private_monitoring
10894 stats enable
10895 stats uri /admin?stats
10896 stats refresh 5s
10897
10898 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10899
10900
10901stats scope { <name> | "." }
10902 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010904 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010905 Arguments :
10906 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10907 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10908 section in which the statement appears.
10909
10910 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10911 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10912 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10913 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10914 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10915 exists.
10916
10917 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10918 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10919 unobvious parameters.
10920
10921 Example :
10922 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10923 backend public_www
10924 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10925 stats enable
10926 stats hide-version
10927 stats scope .
10928 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010929 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010930 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10931 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10932
10933 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10934 backend private_monitoring
10935 stats enable
10936 stats uri /admin?stats
10937 stats refresh 5s
10938
10939 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10940
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010942stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010943 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010945 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010946
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010947 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010948 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10949
10950 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10951 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10952
10953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010955 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010956
10957 Example :
10958 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10959 backend private_monitoring
10960 stats enable
10961 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10962 stats uri /admin?stats
10963 stats refresh 5s
10964
10965 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10966 global section.
10967
10968
10969stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010970 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10972 yes | yes | yes | yes
10973 Arguments : none
10974
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010975 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010976 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10977 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10978 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10979 - IP (socket, server)
10980 - cookie (backend, server)
10981
10982 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10983 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010984 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010985
10986 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10987
10988
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010989stats show-modules
10990 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10992 yes | yes | yes | yes
10993 Arguments : none
10994
10995 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10996 values as a tooltip.
10997
10998 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10999 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11000 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11001
11002 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11003
11004
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011005stats show-node [ <name> ]
11006 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011008 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011009 Arguments:
11010 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11011 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11012
11013 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11014 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011015 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011016
11017 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11018 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11019 unobvious parameters.
11020
11021 Example:
11022 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11023 backend private_monitoring
11024 stats enable
11025 stats show-node Europe-1
11026 stats uri /admin?stats
11027 stats refresh 5s
11028
11029 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11030 section.
11031
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011032
11033stats uri <prefix>
11034 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011037 Arguments :
11038 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11039 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11040 query string.
11041
11042 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11043 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11044 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11045 possible to reach it in the application.
11046
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011047 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011048 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011049 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11050 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11051 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11052 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11053
11054 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11055 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11056 an address or a port to statistics only.
11057
11058 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11059 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11060 unobvious parameters.
11061
11062 Example :
11063 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11064 backend public_www
11065 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11066 stats enable
11067 stats hide-version
11068 stats scope .
11069 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011071 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11072 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11073
11074 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11075 backend private_monitoring
11076 stats enable
11077 stats uri /admin?stats
11078 stats refresh 5s
11079
11080 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11081
11082
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011083stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11084 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011086 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011087
11088 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011089 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011090 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011092 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11093
11094 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11095 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11096 the "stick-table" statement.
11097
11098 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11099 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11100 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11101 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11102 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11103
11104 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11105 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11106 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11107 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11108 transformation rules.
11109
11110 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11111 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11112 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11113 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11114 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11115 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11116 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11117
11118 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11119 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11120 ACL based conditions.
11121
11122 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11123 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11124 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11125 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11126
11127 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11128 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11129 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11130 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11131
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011132 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11133 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011134 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011135
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011136 Example :
11137 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11138 # last 30 minutes
11139 backend pop
11140 mode tcp
11141 balance roundrobin
11142 stick store-request src
11143 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11144 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11145 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11146
11147 backend smtp
11148 mode tcp
11149 balance roundrobin
11150 stick match src table pop
11151 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11152 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11153
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011154 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011155 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011156
11157
11158stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11159 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11161 no | no | yes | yes
11162
11163 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11164 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11165 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11166 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11167
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011168 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11169 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011170 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011171
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011172 Examples :
11173 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011174 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011175
11176 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11177 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11178 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11179
11180
11181 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11182 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11183 backend http
11184 mode http
11185 balance roundrobin
11186 stick on src table https
11187 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11188 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11189 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11190
11191 backend https
11192 mode tcp
11193 balance roundrobin
11194 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11195 stick on src
11196 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11197 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11198
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011199 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011200
11201
11202stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11203 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11205 no | no | yes | yes
11206
11207 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011208 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011209 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011210 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011211 server is selected.
11212
11213 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11214 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11215 the "stick-table" statement.
11216
11217 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11218 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11219 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11220 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11221 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11222 address.
11223
11224 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11225 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11226 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11227 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11228 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11229 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11230 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11231 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11232 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11233 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11234
11235 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11236 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11237 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11238 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11239 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11240 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11241 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11242
11243 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11244 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11245 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11246 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11247
11248 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11249 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11250 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11251 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11252 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11253 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011254 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11255 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11256 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11257 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11258 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11259 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011260
11261 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11262 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11263 the request.
11264
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011265 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11266 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011267 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011268
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269 Example :
11270 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11271 # last 30 minutes
11272 backend pop
11273 mode tcp
11274 balance roundrobin
11275 stick store-request src
11276 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11277 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11278 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11279
11280 backend smtp
11281 mode tcp
11282 balance roundrobin
11283 stick match src table pop
11284 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11285 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11286
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011287 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011288 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011289
11290
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011291stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011292 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011293 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011294 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011296 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011297
11298 Arguments :
11299 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11300 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11301 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11302 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11303
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011304 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11305 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11306 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11307 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11308
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011309 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11310 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11311 instance.
11312
11313 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11314 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11315 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11316 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11317 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11318 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011319 to 32 characters.
11320
11321 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11322 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11323 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011324 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011325 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11326 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011327
11328 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011329 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11330 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011331 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11332 increase.
11333
11334 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011335 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11336 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11337 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011338
11339 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011340 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011341 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11342 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011343 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011344 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11345 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11346 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11347 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11348 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11349 parameter (see below).
11350
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011351 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11352 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11353 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11354 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11355 soft restart.
11356
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011357 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11358 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011359
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011360 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011361 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11362 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011363 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11364 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011365 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011366 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011367 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11368 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011369 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11370 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011371
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011372 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11373 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11374 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11375 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11376 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11377 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11378 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11379 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11380 token.
11381
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011382 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11383 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11384 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11385 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011386 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11387 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11388 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11389 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11390 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11391 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11392 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11393 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11394 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11395 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11396 types and their arguments.
11397
11398 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11399 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11400 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11401 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11402
11403 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11404 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11405 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011406 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011407
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011408 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11409 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11410 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011411 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011412 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011413 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011414
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011415 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11416 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11417 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11418 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11419
11420 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11421 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11422 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11423 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11424 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11425 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11426
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011427 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11428 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11429 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11430 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11431
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011432 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11433 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11434 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11435 they were received.
11436
11437 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11438 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11439 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11440 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11441 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11442
11443 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11444 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11445 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11446 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11447 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11448
11449 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11450 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11451 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11452
11453 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11454 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11455 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11456 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11457 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11458
11459 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11460 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11461 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11462 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11463 the client side.
11464
11465 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11466 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11467 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11468 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11469 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11470 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11471 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11472
11473 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11474 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11475 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11476 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11477 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11478 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011479 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011480
11481 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11482 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11483 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11484 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11485 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11486 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11487
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011488 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11489 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11490 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11491 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11492 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11493
11494 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11495 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11496 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11497 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11498 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11499 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11500
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011501 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011502 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011503 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11504 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11505
11506 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11507 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11508 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11509 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11510 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11511 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11512 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11513 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11514 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11515 recommended for better fairness.
11516
11517 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011518 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011519 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11520 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11521
11522 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11523 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11524 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11525 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11526 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11527 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11528 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11529 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11530 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11531 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011532
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011533 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11534 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011535 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11536 reference it.
11537
11538 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11539 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011540 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11541 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11542 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011543
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011544 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11545 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11546 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11547 something that can be ignored.
11548
11549 Example:
11550 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11551 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11552 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11553 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11554
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011555 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011556 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011557
11558
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011559stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011560 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011561 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11562 no | no | yes | yes
11563
11564 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011565 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011566 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011567 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011568 server is selected.
11569
11570 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11571 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11572 the "stick-table" statement.
11573
11574 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11575 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11576 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11577 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11578
11579 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11580 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11581 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11582 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11583 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11584 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011585 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011586 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11587 rules.
11588
11589 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11590 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11591 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11592 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11593 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11594 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11595 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11596
11597 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11598 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11599 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11600 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11601
11602 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11603 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11604 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11605 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11606 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11607 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011608 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11609 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11610 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11611 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11612 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11613 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11614 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11615 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11616 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011617
11618 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11619
11620 Example :
11621 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11622 backend https
11623 mode tcp
11624 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011625 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011626 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011627
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011628 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11629 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011630
11631 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11632 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11633 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11634
11635 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11636 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011637
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011638 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11639 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11640 # at offset 44.
11641
11642 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011643 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011644
11645 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011646 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011647
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011648 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11649 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11650
11651 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11652 extraction.
11653
11654
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011655tcp-check comment <string>
11656 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11657 it fails.
11658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11659 yes | no | yes | yes
11660
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011661 Arguments :
11662 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11663 rule fails.
11664
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011665 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11666 user-friendly error reporting.
11667
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011668 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11669 "tcp-check expect".
11670
11671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011672tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11673 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011674 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011675 Opens a new connection
11676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011677 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011679 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011680 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11681
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011682 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011683 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011684
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011685 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011686 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11687 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011688 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011689
11690 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011691
11692 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11693
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011694 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11695
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011696 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11697
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011698 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11699
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011700 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11701 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11702 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11703 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11704
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011705 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11706 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11707 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11708 haproxy -vv.
11709
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011710 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011711
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011712 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11713 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11714 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11715
11716 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11717 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11718 of the sequence.
11719
11720 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11721 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11722 do.
11723
11724 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11725 unset-var or comment rules.
11726
11727 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011728 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11729 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11730 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11731 option tcp-check
11732 tcp-check connect
11733 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11734 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11735 tcp-check send \r\n
11736 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11737 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11738 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11739 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11740 tcp-check send \r\n
11741 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11742 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11743
11744 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11745 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011746 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011747 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11748 tcp-check connect port 143
11749 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11750 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11751
11752 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11753
11754
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011755tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011756 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011757 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011758 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011759 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011761 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011762
11763 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011764 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11765
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011766 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11767 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11768 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11769 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11770 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11771 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11772 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11773 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11774 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11775 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11776
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011777 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011778 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11779 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011780 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11781 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11782 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11783
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011784 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11785 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11786 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011787 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11788 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011789 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11790 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011791 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11792 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011793 By default "L7OK" is used.
11794
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011795 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11796 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011797 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11798 supported :
11799 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11800 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011801 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11802 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11803 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11804 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11805 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011806
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011807 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011808 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011809 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11810 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11811 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11812 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011813 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11814
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011815 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11816 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11817 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11818 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11819
11820 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11821 informational message reported in logs if an error
11822 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11823 log-format string.
11824
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011825 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11826 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11827 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11828 followed by some converters.
11829
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011830 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11831 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11832 with the usual backslash ('\').
11833 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011834 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011835 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11836 used upper or lower case.
11837
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011838 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11839
11840 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11841 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11842 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11843 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11844 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11845 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11846 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11847 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11848
11849 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11851 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11852 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11853 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11854 expression.
11855
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011856 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11858 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11859 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11860 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11861 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11862
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011863 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11864 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11865 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11866 this exact hexadecimal string.
11867 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11868
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011869 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11870 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11871 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11872 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11873 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11874 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11875 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11876 size.
11877
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011878 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11879 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11880 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11881 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11882 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11883 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11884 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11885 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11886 in a binary string before matching the response's
11887 buffer.
11888
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011889 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011890 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011891 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11892 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11893 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11894 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11895 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11896 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11897 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11898 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11899 the null character.
11900
11901 Examples :
11902 # perform a POP check
11903 option tcp-check
11904 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11905
11906 # perform an IMAP check
11907 option tcp-check
11908 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11909
11910 # look for the redis master server
11911 option tcp-check
11912 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011913 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011914 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11915 tcp-check expect string role:master
11916 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11917 tcp-check expect string +OK
11918
11919
11920 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011921 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011922
11923
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011924tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11925tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11926 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11927 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011928 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011929 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011930
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011931 Arguments :
11932 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11933
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011934 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11935 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011936
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011937 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11938 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011939
11940 Examples :
11941 # look for the redis master server
11942 option tcp-check
11943 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11944 tcp-check expect string role:master
11945
11946 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011947 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011948
11949
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011950tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11951tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11952 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11953 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011956
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011957 Arguments :
11958 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011959
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011960 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11961 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011962
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011963 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11964 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11965 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011966
11967 Examples :
11968 # redis check in binary
11969 option tcp-check
11970 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11971 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11972
11973
11974 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011975 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011976
11977
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011978tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011979 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011981 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011982
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011983 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011984 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11985 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11988 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11989 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11990 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11991 and '-'.
11992
11993 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11994
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011995 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011996 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11997
11998
11999tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012000 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012002 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012003
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012004 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12006 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12009 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12011 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12012 and '-'.
12013
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012014 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012015 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12016
12017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012018tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12019 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12021 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012023 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12024 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012025
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012026 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012027
12028 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12029 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012030 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12031 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12032 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12033 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12034 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12035 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012037 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12038 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12039 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12040 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012041
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012042 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012043 - accept :
12044 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12045 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12046 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012047
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012048 - reject :
12049 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12050 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12051 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12052 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12053 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12054 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12055 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12056 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12057 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12058 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12059 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012060 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012061
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012062 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12063 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12064 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12065 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12066 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12067 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12068 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12069 hosts.
12070
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012071 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12072 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12073 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12074 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12075 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12076 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12077 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12078 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12079
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012080 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12081 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12082 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12083 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12084 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12085 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12086 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12087 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12088 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012089 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12090 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012091
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012092 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012093 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012094 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12095 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12096 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012097 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012098 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012099 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12100 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12101 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12102 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12103 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12104 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12105 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012106
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012107 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012108 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012109 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012110 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012111 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12112 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12113 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012114
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012115 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12116 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12117 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12118 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012119
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012120 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12121 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12122 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12123 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12124 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012125 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12126 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12127 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12128 layer7 information is extracted.
12129
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012130 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12131 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12132 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12133 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12134 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012135
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012136 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12137 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12138 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12139 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12140
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012141 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12142 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12143 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12144 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12145
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012146 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12147 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12148 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12149 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12150 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012151
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012152 - set-src <expr> :
12153 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12154 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12155 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012156 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012158 Arguments:
12159 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12160 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012161
12162 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012163 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12164
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012165 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12166 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012167
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012168 - set-src-port <expr> :
12169 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12170 expression.
12171
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012172 Arguments:
12173 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12174 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012175
12176 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012177 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12178
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012179 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12180 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12181 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012182
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012183 - set-dst <expr> :
12184 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12185 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12186 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12187 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12188 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12189
12190 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12191 followed by some converters.
12192
12193 Example:
12194
12195 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12196 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12197
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012198 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12199 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12200
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012201 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12202 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12203 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12204 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12205
12206
12207 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12208 followed by some converters.
12209
12210 Example:
12211
12212 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12213
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012214 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12215 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12216 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12217
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012218 - "silent-drop" :
12219 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012220 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012221 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12222 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12223 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12224 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12225 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12227 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012228 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12229 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012230 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012231 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12232 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12233 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12234 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012236 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12237 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12238 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012239
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012240 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12241 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12242 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012244 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012245 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012246 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012248 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12249 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12250 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012252 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012253 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12254 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012255
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012256 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12257
12258 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12259
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012260 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12261
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012262 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012263
12264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12266 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012268 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012269 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012270 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12271 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012273 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012274
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012275 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012276 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12277 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012278 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12279 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012281 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12282 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12283 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12284 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012285 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012286 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012287 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12288 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12289 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12290 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012291 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012292 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12295 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12296 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12297 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012298
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012299 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012300 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012301 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012302 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12303 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012304 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012305 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012306 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012307 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012308 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012309 - set-dst <expr>
12310 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012311 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012312 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012313 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012314 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012315 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012316 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012317
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012318 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12319 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012320 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12321 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012322
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012323 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12324 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12325 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12326 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12327 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12328 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012329
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012330 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012331 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12332 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012333
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012334 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12335 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12336 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12337 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12338 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12339 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12340
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012341 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012342 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12343 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12344 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12345 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12346 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12347 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12348 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12349 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12350 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12351 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012352
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012353 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012354 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12355 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12356 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012357
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012358 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12359 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12360
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012361 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012362 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12363 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012364
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012365 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12366 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012370 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012371 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012372 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012373 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12374 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012375 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012376 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12377 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012378
12379 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12380 followed by some converters.
12381
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012382 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012383 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12384 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12385 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12386 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12387 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12388 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012389 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012390 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12391 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12392
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012393 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12394
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012395 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12396 <var-name>.
12397
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012398 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12399 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12400 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12401 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12402 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12403
12404 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12405 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12406 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12407 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12408 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12409 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12410 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12411 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12412 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12413 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12414 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12415
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012416 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12417 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12418 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12419 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12420 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12421
12422 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12423
12424 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12425
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012426 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12427 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12428 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12429 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12430 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12431 evaluated.
12432
12433 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012434 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012435
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012436 Example:
12437
12438 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012439 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012440
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012441 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012442 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012443 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012444 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12445 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012446 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012447 tcp-request content reject
12448
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012449 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12450 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12451 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12452 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12453 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12454 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12455 ...
12456 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12457
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012458 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012459 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12460 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012461 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012462 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012463
12464 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12465 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012466 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012467 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012468 tcp-request content reject
12469
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012470 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012471 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012472 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012473 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012474 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12475 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012476
12477 Example:
12478 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12479 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012480 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012481
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012482 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012483 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012484
12485 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012486 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012487 # protecting all our sites
12488 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012489 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12490 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012491 ...
12492 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12493
12494 backend http_dynamic
12495 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012496 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012497 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012498 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012499 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012500 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012501 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012503 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012504
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012505 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12506 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012507
12508
12509tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12510 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12511 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012512 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012513 Arguments :
12514 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12515 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12516 as explained at the top of this document.
12517
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012518 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012519 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12520 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12521 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12522 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12523
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012524 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12525 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12526 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12527 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12528
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012529 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012531 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012532 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012533 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012534 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12535 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12536 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012537
12538 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12539 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12540 it pass through unaffected.
12541
12542 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12543 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12544 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012545 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012546 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12547 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012548 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12549 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12550 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012552 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012553 "timeout client".
12554
12555
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012556tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12557 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12559 no | no | yes | yes
12560 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012561 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12562 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012563
12564 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12565
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012566 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012567 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12568 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012569 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12570 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012571
12572 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12573
12574 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12575 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12576 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12577 inserted.
12578
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012579 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012580 - accept :
12581 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12582 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12583 the rules evaluation.
12584
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012585 - close :
12586 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12587 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12588 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12589 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12590 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12591 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012592 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012593 protocols.
12594
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012595 - reject :
12596 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12597 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012598 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012599
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012600 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012601 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012602
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012603 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12604 Unsets a variable.
12605
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012606 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12607 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12608 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12609 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012611 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12612 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12613 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12614 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12615
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012616 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12617 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12618 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12619 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12620 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012621
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012622 - "silent-drop" :
12623 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012624 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012625 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12626 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12627 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12628 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12629 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012630 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12631 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012632 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12633 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012634 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012635 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12636 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12637 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12638 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12639
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012640 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12641 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12642
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012643 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12644 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12645 for changing the default action to a reject.
12646
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012647 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12648 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12649 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12650 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012651 period.
12652
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012653 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12654 declared inline.
12655
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012656 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12657 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012658 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012659 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12660 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012661 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012663 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012664 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12665 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012666 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012667 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12668 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012669
12670 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12671 followed by some converters.
12672
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012673 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12674 <var-name>.
12675
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012676 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12677 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12678 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12679 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12680 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12681
12682 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12683
12684 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12685
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012686 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12687
12688 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12689
12690
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012691tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12692 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12694 no | yes | yes | no
12695 Arguments :
12696 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12697 below.
12698
12699 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12700
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012701 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012702 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12703 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12704 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12705 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12706 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12707 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12708 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012709 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012710 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12711 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12712 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12713 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12714 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12715 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12716 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12717 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12718 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12719 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12720 instead.
12721
12722 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12723 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12724 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12725 rules which may be inserted.
12726
12727 Several types of actions are supported :
12728 - accept : the request is accepted
12729 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12730 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12731 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012732 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012733 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012734 - set-dst <expr>
12735 - set-dst-port <expr>
12736 - set-src <expr>
12737 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012738 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012739 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012740 - silent-drop
12741
12742 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12743 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12744 sections for a complete description.
12745
12746 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12747 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12748 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12749
12750 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12751 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12752 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12753 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12754 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12755
12756 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12757 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12758
12759 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12760 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12761 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12762
12763 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12764 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12766
12767 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12768 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12769 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12770
12771 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12772 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12773 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12774
12775 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12776
12777 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12778
12779
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012780tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12781 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12783 no | no | yes | yes
12784 Arguments :
12785 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12786 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12787 as explained at the top of this document.
12788
12789 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12790
12791
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012792timeout check <timeout>
12793 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12794 established.
12795
12796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12797 yes | no | yes | yes
12798 Arguments:
12799 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12800 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12801 as explained at the top of this document.
12802
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012803 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012804 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012805 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012806 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012807 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12808 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12809 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012811 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012812 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12813
12814 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12815 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012816 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012817
12818 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12819 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12820 forget about it.
12821
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012822 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12823 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012824
12825
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012826timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012827 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12829 yes | yes | yes | no
12830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12833 as explained at the top of this document.
12834
12835 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12836 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12837 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012838 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12839 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12840 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12841 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012842 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12843 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12844 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012845 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012846 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012847 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12848 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012849 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12850 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012851
12852 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12853 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12854 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12855 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012856 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012857 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12858
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012859 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012860
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012861
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012862timeout client-fin <timeout>
12863 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12864 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12865 yes | yes | yes | no
12866 Arguments :
12867 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12868 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12869 as explained at the top of this document.
12870
12871 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12872 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12873 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12874 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12875 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12876 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12877 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012878 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12879 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12880 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012881
12882 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12883 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12884 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12885
12886 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12887
12888
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012889timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012890 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12892 yes | no | yes | yes
12893 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012894 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012895 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12896 as explained at the top of this document.
12897
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012898 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012899 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012900 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012901 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012902 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12903 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012904
12905 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12906 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12907 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12908 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012909 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012910 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12911
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012912 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012914
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012915timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12916 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12918 yes | yes | yes | yes
12919 Arguments :
12920 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12921 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12922 as explained at the top of this document.
12923
12924 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12925 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12926 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12927 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12928 once the request has started to present itself.
12929
12930 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12931 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12932 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12933 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12934 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12935
12936 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12937 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12938 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12939 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12940
12941 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12942 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012943 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012944 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12945 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012946 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012947
12948 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12949 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12950 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12951 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12952
12953 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12954
12955
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012956timeout http-request <timeout>
12957 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012959 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012960 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012961 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012962 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12963 as explained at the top of this document.
12964
12965 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12966 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12967 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12968 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12969 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12970 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12971 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012972 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12973 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12974 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12975 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012976 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012977 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12978 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012979
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012980 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12981 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12982 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12983 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12984 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012985 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012986
12987 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12988 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012989 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012990 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12991 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12992
12993 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012994 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12995 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12996 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012997
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012998 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012999 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013001
13002timeout queue <timeout>
13003 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13005 yes | no | yes | yes
13006 Arguments :
13007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13009 as explained at the top of this document.
13010
13011 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13012 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13013 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13014 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13015 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13016
13017 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13018 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13019 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13020 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13021
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013022 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013023
13024
13025timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013026 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13028 yes | no | yes | yes
13029 Arguments :
13030 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13031 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13032 as explained at the top of this document.
13033
13034 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13035 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13036 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13037 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13038 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13039 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13040 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13041
13042 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13043 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13044 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13045 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13046 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013047 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013048 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013049 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13050 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013051 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13052 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013053
13054 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13055 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13056 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13057 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013058 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013059 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13060
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013061 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013062
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013063
13064timeout server-fin <timeout>
13065 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13067 yes | no | yes | yes
13068 Arguments :
13069 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13070 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13071 as explained at the top of this document.
13072
13073 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13074 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13075 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13076 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13077 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13078 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13079 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13080 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13081 situations, it should not be needed.
13082
13083 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13084 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13085 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13086
13087 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13088
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013089
13090timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013091 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13093 yes | yes | yes | yes
13094 Arguments :
13095 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13096 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13097 as explained at the top of this document.
13098
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013099 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13100 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13101 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013102
13103 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13104 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13105 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13106 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013107 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013108
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013109 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013110
13111
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013112timeout tunnel <timeout>
13113 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13115 yes | no | yes | yes
13116 Arguments :
13117 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13118 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13119 as explained at the top of this document.
13120
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013121 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013122 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13123 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13124 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013125 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13126 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013127 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13128 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13129 specified.
13130
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013131 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13132 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13133 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13134 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13135 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13136 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13137 state.
13138
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013139 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13140 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13141 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13142 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013143 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013144
13145 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13146 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13147 forget about it.
13148
13149 Example :
13150 defaults http
13151 option http-server-close
13152 timeout connect 5s
13153 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013154 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013155 timeout server 30s
13156 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13157
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013158 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013159
13160
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013161transparent (deprecated)
13162 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013164 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013165 Arguments : none
13166
13167 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13168 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13169 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13170 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13171 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13172 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13173 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13174 appropriate server.
13175
13176 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13177
13178 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13179 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13180
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013181 See also: "option transparent"
13182
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013183unique-id-format <string>
13184 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13186 yes | yes | yes | no
13187 Arguments :
13188 <string> is a log-format string.
13189
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013190 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13191 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13192 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13193 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013194
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013195 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013196 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013197 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13198 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13199 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13200 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13201 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13202 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013204 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13205 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013206
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013207 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013208
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013209 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013210
13211 will generate:
13212
13213 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13214
13215 See also: "unique-id-header"
13216
13217unique-id-header <name>
13218 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13220 yes | yes | yes | no
13221 Arguments :
13222 <name> is the name of the header.
13223
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013224 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13225 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013226
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013227 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013228
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013229 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013230 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13231
13232 will generate:
13233
13234 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13235
13236 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013237
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013238use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013239 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13241 no | yes | yes | no
13242 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013243 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13244 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013245
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013246 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13247 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013248
13249 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13250 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13251 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013252 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013253 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013254 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13255 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013256
13257 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13258 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13259 assign the backend.
13260
13261 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13262 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13263 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13264 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13265 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13266 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13267
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013268 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013269 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013270 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13271 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13272 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13273
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013274 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13275 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13276 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13277 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13278 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13279 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13280 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13281 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13282 cannot be forced from the request.
13283
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013284 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013285 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13286 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13287
13288 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13289 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013290
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013291use-fcgi-app <name>
13292 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13293 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13294 no | no | yes | yes
13295 Arguments :
13296 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13297
13298 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013299
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013300use-server <server> if <condition>
13301use-server <server> unless <condition>
13302 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13304 no | no | yes | yes
13305 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013306 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13307 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013308
13309 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13310
13311 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13312 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13313 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13314
13315 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13316 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13317 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13318 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13319 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13320 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13321 matches will assign the server.
13322
13323 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13324 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13325 with the next rules until one matches.
13326
13327 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13328 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13329 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13330 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13331
13332 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13333 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13334 stripped.
13335
13336 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13337 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013338 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013339 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013340 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013341
13342 Example :
13343 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013344 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013345 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013346 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013347 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013348 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013349 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013350 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13351 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13352
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013353 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13354 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13355 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13356 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013357 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013358 and we fall back to load balancing.
13359
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013360 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013361
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013362
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013364--------------------------
13365
13366The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13367depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13368settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13369written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13370described in this section.
13371
13372
133735.1. Bind options
13374-----------------
13375
13376The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13377as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13378no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13379parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13380while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13381provided immediately after the setting name.
13382
13383The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13384
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013385accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13386 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13387 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13388 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13389 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13390 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13391 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13392 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13393 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13394 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013395 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13396 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13397 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013398
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013399accept-proxy
13400 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013401 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13402 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013403 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13404 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13405 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13406 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013407 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013408 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13409 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013410 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13411 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013412
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013413allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013414 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013415 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013416 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013417 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13418 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013419
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013420alpn <protocols>
13421 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13422 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13423 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013424 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013425 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013426 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13427 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13428 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13429 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13430 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13431 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13432 preference, like below :
13433
13434 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013436backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013437 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013438 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13439
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013440curves <curves>
13441 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13442 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13443 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13444 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13445 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13446 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13447
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013448ecdhe <named curve>
13449 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013450 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13451 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013452
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013453ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13455 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13456 client's certificate.
13457
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013458ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13459 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13460 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13461 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13462 error is ignored.
13463
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013464ca-sign-file <cafile>
13465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13466 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13467 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13468 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13469 'generate-certificates' for details.
13470
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013471ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13473 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13474 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13475 'generate-certificates' for details.
13476
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013477ca-verify-file <cafile>
13478 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13479 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13480 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13481 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13482 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13483
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013484ciphers <ciphers>
13485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13486 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013487 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013488 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013489 information and recommendations see e.g.
13490 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13491 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13492 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13493
13494ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13496 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13497 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13498 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013499 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13500 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013501
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013502crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13504 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013505 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13506 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013507
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013508crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13510 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13511 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13512 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13513 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013514 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13515 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013516
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013517 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13518 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13519
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013520 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13521 are loaded.
13522
13523 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013524 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13525 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13526 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13527 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13528 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13529 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13530 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013531 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013532
13533 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13534 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13535 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13536 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013537 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13538 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013539
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013540 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013541
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013542 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013543 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013544 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13545 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013546 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13547 clients).
13548
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013549 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013550 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13551 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13552 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13553 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13554 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13555 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13556 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13557 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13558 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13559 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13560 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13561 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13562
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013563 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013564 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13565 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13566 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13567 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13568
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013569 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13570 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13571 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13572 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013573
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013574 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13575 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13576 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013577
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013578crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013579 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013580 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013581 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013582 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013583
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013584crt-list <file>
13585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013586 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13587 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013588
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013589 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13590
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013591 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13592 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13593 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13594 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13595 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013596
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013597 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013598 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13599 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13600 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13601 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13602 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013603 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13604 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13605 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013606
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013607 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13608 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13609 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013610
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013611 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13612
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013613 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013614 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013615 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13616 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13617 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13618 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13619 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13620 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013621
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013622 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013623 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013624 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013625 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013626 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013627 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013628
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013629defer-accept
13630 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13631 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13632 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013633 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013634 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13635 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13636 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13637 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13638 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13639 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13640 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13641
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013642expose-fd listeners
13643 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13644 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013645 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13646 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013647 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013648
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013649force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013650 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013651 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013652 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013653 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013654
13655force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013656 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013657 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013658 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013659
13660force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013661 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013662 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013663 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013664
13665force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013666 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013667 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013668 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013669
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013670force-tlsv13
13671 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13672 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013673 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013674
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013675generate-certificates
13676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13677 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13678 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13679 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13680 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13681 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13682 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13683 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13684 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13685 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13686 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13687
13688 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13689 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013690 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013691 certificate is used many times.
13692
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013693gid <gid>
13694 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13695 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13696 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13697 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13698 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13699
13700group <group>
13701 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13702 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13703 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13704 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13705 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13706
13707id <id>
13708 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13709 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13710 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13711 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13712
13713interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013714 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13715 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13716 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13717 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13718 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13719 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013720 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13721 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13722 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13723 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13724 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13725 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013726
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013727level <level>
13728 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13729 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13730 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013731 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013732 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13733 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13734 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013735 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013736 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013737 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013738 all counters).
13739
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013740severity-output <format>
13741 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13742 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13743 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13744 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13745 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13746 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13747 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13748 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13749 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13750 rfc5424 convention.
13751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013752maxconn <maxconn>
13753 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13754 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13755 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13756 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13757 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13758 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13759 eat all memory.
13760
13761mode <mode>
13762 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13763 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13764 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13765 UNIX sockets.
13766
13767mss <maxseg>
13768 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13769 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13770 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13771 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13772 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13773 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13774 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13775 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13776 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13777 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13778 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13779
13780name <name>
13781 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13782 page.
13783
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013784namespace <name>
13785 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13786 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13787 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13788 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13789
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013790nice <nice>
13791 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13792 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13793 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13794 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13795 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13796 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13797 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13798 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13799 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13800 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13801 one for an RDP socket.
13802
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013803no-ca-names
13804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13805 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013806 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013807
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013808no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013810 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013811 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013812 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013813 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13814 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013815
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013816no-tls-tickets
13817 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13818 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13819 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013820 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13821 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013822 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13823 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13824 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013825
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013826no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013828 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013829 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013830 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013831 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13832 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013833
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013834no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013835 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013836 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013837 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013838 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013839 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13840 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013841
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013842no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013844 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013845 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013846 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013847 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13848 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013849
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013850no-tlsv13
13851 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13852 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13853 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13854 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013855 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13856 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013857
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013858npn <protocols>
13859 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13860 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13861 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013862 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013863 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013864 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13865 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13866 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13867 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13868 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013869
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013870prefer-client-ciphers
13871 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13872 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13873 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013874 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13875 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13876 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013877
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013878process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013879 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013880 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013881 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013882 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13883 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13884 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13885 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013886 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013887 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13888 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13889 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13890 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13891 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013892
13893 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13894
13895 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13896 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13897 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13898 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13899 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13900 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13901 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13902 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013903
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013904proto <name>
13905 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13906 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13907 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013908 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13909 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13910
13911 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13912 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13913 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13914 also reported (flag=HTX).
13915
13916 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13917 a bind line :
13918
13919 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13920 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13921 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13922
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013923 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013924 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013925 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013926 h2" on the bind line.
13927
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013928ssl
13929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013930 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013931 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13932 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013933 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13934 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013935
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013936ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13937 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013938 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13939 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13940 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013941 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13942
13943ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013944 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13945 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13946 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13947 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013948
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013949strict-sni
13950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13951 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13952 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13953 See the "crt" option for more information.
13954
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013955tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013956 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013957 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013958 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013959 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013960 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13961 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13962 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13963 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13964 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13965 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13966 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13967
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013968tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013969 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013970 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13971 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13972 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13973 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13974 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13975 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13976 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013977 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13978 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13979 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013980
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013981tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13982 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013983 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13984 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13985 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13986 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13987 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13988 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13989 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13990 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13991 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13992 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013993 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13994 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13995
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013996transparent
13997 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13998 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13999 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14000 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14001 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14002 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14003 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14004 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14005 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14006 so check for support with your vendor.
14007
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014008v4v6
14009 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14010 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14011 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14012 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014013 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014014
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014015v6only
14016 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14017 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14018 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014019 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14020 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014021
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014022uid <uid>
14023 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14024 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14025 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14026 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14027 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14028
14029user <user>
14030 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14031 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14032 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14033 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14034 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14035
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014036verify [none|optional|required]
14037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14038 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14039 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14040 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14041 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014042 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14043 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14044 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14045 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014046
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140475.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014048------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014050The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14051which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14052arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14053settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14054after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14055Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14056address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014058 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014059 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014060
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014061Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14062keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14063
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014064The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014065
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014066addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014067 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014068 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14069 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14070 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14071 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14072 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014073
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014074agent-check
14075 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014076 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014077 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14078 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14079 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014080
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014081 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014082 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014083 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014084 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14085 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014086
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14088 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14089 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14090 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14091 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014094 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014095
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014096 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14097 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14098 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014099
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014100 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14101 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14102 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014104 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014105 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14106 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14107 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14108 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014109 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014110 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014111
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014112 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14113 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014114
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014115 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14116 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14117 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14118 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14119 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14120 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14121 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14122 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14123 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014124
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014125 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14126 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014127 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14128 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14129 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014130 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014131
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014132 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014133 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014134
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014135agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014136 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014137 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14138 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14139 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14140 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14141
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014142agent-inter <delay>
14143 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14144 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14145
14146 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14147 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14148 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14149 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14150 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14151 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14152 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14153 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14154 of backends use the same servers.
14155
14156 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14157
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014158agent-addr <addr>
14159 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14160
14161 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014162 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014163 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14164 hostname, it will be resolved.
14165
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014166agent-port <port>
14167 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14168
14169 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14170
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014171allow-0rtt
14172 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014173 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14174 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014175
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014176alpn <protocols>
14177 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14178 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14179 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014180 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014181 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14182 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14183 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14184 now obsolete NPN extension.
14185 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14186 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14187
14188 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14189
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014190 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14191
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014192backup
14193 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14194 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14195 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14196 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014197 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14198 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014199
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014200ca-file <cafile>
14201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14202 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14203 server's certificate.
14204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014205check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014206 This option enables health checks on a server:
14207 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14208 considered available.
14209 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14210 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14211 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14212 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14213 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14214 set.
14215 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14216 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14217 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14218 exchanges succeed.
14219
14220 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14221 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14222 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14223 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14224 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014225 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014226 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14227
14228 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14229 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14230
14231 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14232 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14233
14234 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14235 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14236 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14237 available.
14238
14239 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14240 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14241 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14242
14243 Example:
14244 # simple tcp check
14245 backend foo
14246 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14247 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14248 backend foo
14249 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14250 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14251 backend foo
14252 option tcp-check
14253 tcp-check connect
14254 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014255
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014256check-send-proxy
14257 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14258 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14259 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14260 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14261 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14262 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14263 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14264
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014265check-alpn <protocols>
14266 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14267 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14268 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14269
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014270check-proto <name>
14271 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14272 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14273 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014274 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14275 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14276
14277 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14278 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14279 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14280 also reported (flag=HTX).
14281
14282 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14283 directive on a server line:
14284
14285 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14286 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14287 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14288 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14289
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014290 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014291 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14292 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14293
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014294check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014295 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014296 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14297 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014298
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014299check-ssl
14300 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14301 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14302 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14303 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014304 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014305 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14306 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014307 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014308 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14309 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014310
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014311check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014312 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014313 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14314 for normal traffic.
14315
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014316ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014317 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14318 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14319 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014320 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14321 information and recommendations see e.g.
14322 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14323 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14324 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014325
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014326ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14328 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14329 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14330 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014331 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14332 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14333 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014334
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014335cookie <value>
14336 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14337 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14338 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14339 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14340 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14341 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14342 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14343
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014344crl-file <crlfile>
14345 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14346 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14347 to verify server's certificate.
14348
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014349crt <cert>
14350 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14351 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14352 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14353 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14354 certificate request.
14355
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014356 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14357 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14358 option is set accordingly).
14359
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014360disabled
14361 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14362 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14363 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14364 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14365 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014366 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014367
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014368enabled
14369 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14370 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14371 default value.
14372 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14373 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014375error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014376 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14377 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14378 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014380 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014382fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014383 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14384 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14385 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14386
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014387force-sslv3
14388 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14389 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014390 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014391 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014392
14393force-tlsv10
14394 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014395 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014396 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014397
14398force-tlsv11
14399 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014400 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014401 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014402
14403force-tlsv12
14404 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014405 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014406 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014407
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014408force-tlsv13
14409 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14410 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014411 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014412
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014413id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014414 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14415 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14416 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014417
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014418init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14419 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14420 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014422 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14423 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14424 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14425 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14426 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14427 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14428 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14429 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14430 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014432 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14433 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14434 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14435 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14436 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14437 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014439
14440 Example:
14441 defaults
14442 # never fail on address resolution
14443 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014445inter <delay>
14446fastinter <delay>
14447downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014448 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14449 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14450 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14451 between checks depending on the server state :
14452
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014453 Server state | Interval used
14454 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14455 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14456 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14457 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14458 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14459 or yet unchecked. |
14460 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14461 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14462 | "inter" otherwise.
14463 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014465 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14466 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14467 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14468 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014469 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14470 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14471 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14472 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14473 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014474
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014475log-proto <logproto>
14476 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14477 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14478 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14479 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014481maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014482 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14483 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014484 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14485 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014486 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14487 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14488 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14489 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14490
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014491 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14492 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14493 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14494 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14495 than 50 concurrent requests.
14496
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014497maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014498 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14499 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14500 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14501 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014502 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14503 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14504 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14505 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14506 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14507 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14508 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014509
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014510max-reuse <count>
14511 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14512 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14513 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14514 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14515 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14516 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14517 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14518 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014520minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014521 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14522 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14523 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14524 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14525 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14526 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014527 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014528 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014529
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014530namespace <name>
14531 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14532 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14533 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14534 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14535
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014536no-agent-check
14537 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14538 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14539 default value.
14540 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14541 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14542
14543no-backup
14544 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14545 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14546 default value.
14547 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14548 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14549
14550no-check
14551 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14552 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14553 default value.
14554 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14555 "default-server" "check" setting.
14556
14557no-check-ssl
14558 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14559 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14560 default value.
14561 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14562 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14563
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014564no-send-proxy
14565 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14566 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14567 default value.
14568 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14569 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14570
14571no-send-proxy-v2
14572 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14573 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14574 default value.
14575 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14576 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14577
14578no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14583 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14584
14585no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14588 default value.
14589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14590 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14591
14592no-ssl
14593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14595 default value.
14596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14597 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14598
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014599 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14600 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14601 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14602
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014603no-ssl-reuse
14604 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14605 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14606 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14607 and for paranoid users.
14608
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014609no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014610 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14611 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014612 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014613
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014614 Supported in default-server: No
14615
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014616no-tls-tickets
14617 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14618 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14619 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014620 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14621 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014622 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14623 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14624 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014625 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014626
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014627no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014628 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014629 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14630 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014631 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14632 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014633 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014634
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014635 Supported in default-server: No
14636
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014637no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014638 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014639 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14640 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014641 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14642 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014643 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014644
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014645 Supported in default-server: No
14646
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014647no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014648 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014649 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14650 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014651 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14652 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014653 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014654
14655 Supported in default-server: No
14656
14657no-tlsv13
14658 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14659 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14660 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14661 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14662 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014663 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014664
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014665 Supported in default-server: No
14666
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014667no-verifyhost
14668 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14669 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14670 default value.
14671 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14672 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014673
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014674no-tfo
14675 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14676 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14677 default value.
14678 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14679 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14680
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014681non-stick
14682 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14683 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14684 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14685
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014686npn <protocols>
14687 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14688 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14689 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014690 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014691 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14692 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14693 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014695observe <mode>
14696 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14697 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14698 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14699 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14700 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14701 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014702 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014703
14704 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014706on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014707 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14708 Currently, four modes are available:
14709 - fastinter: force fastinter
14710 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14711 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14712 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14713 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14714
14715 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14716
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014717on-marked-down <action>
14718 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14719 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014720 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14721 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14722 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14723 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14724 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14725 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14726 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14727 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014728
14729 Actions are disabled by default
14730
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014731on-marked-up <action>
14732 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14733 Currently one action is available:
14734 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14735 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14736 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14737 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014738 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14739 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014740 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14741 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14742
14743 Actions are disabled by default
14744
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014745pool-low-conn <max>
14746 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14747 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14748 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14749 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14750 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14751 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14752 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14753 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14754 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14755 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014756 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14757 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14758 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14759 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014760
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014761pool-max-conn <max>
14762 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14763 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14764 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14765 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14766 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14767 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14768
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014769pool-purge-delay <delay>
14770 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014771 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014772 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014774port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014775 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014776 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14777 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14778 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14779 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14780 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014781
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014782proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014783 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14784 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14785 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014786 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14787 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14788
14789 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14790 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14791 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14792 also reported (flag=HTX).
14793
14794 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14795 a server line :
14796
14797 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14798 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14799 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14800 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14801
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014802 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014803 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14804
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014805 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014807redir <prefix>
14808 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14809 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14810 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14811 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14812 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14813 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14814 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14815 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014816 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014817 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014818 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14819 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14820 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14821 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14822
14823 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014825rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014826 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14827 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14828 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14829
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014830resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14831 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14832 server.
14833
14834 Available options:
14835
14836 * allow-dup-ip
14837 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14838 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14839 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14840 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14841 For such case, simply enable this option.
14842 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14843
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014844 * ignore-weight
14845 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14846 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14847 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14848
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014849 * prevent-dup-ip
14850 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14851 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14852 same fqdn.
14853 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14854
14855 Example:
14856 backend b_myapp
14857 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14858 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14859 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14860
14861 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14862 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14863 it
14864 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14865 different address
14866
14867 Default value: not set
14868
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014869resolve-prefer <family>
14870 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14871 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14872 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14873 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14874
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014875 Default value: ipv6
14876
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014877 Example:
14878
14879 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014880
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014881resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014882 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014883 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014884 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014885 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14886 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014887 configured network, another address is selected.
14888
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014889 Example:
14890
14891 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014892
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014893resolvers <id>
14894 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14895 hostname.
14896
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014897 Example:
14898
14899 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014900
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014901 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014902
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014903send-proxy
14904 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14905 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14906 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14907 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014908 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14909 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14910 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14911 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014912 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014913 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14914 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14915 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14916 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14917 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014918 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14919 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014920
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014921send-proxy-v2
14922 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14923 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14924 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14925 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014926 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14927 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14928 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14929 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014930
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014931proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014932 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14933 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14934
14935 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14936 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14937 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14938 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14939 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14940 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14941 connection is supported).
14942 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14943 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14944 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14945 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14946 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14947 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14948 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014949
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014950send-proxy-v2-ssl
14951 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14952 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14953 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14954 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14955 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14956 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14957 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014958 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14959 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014960
14961send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14962 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14963 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14964 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14965 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14966 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14967 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14968 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14969 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014970 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14971 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014973slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014974 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14975 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14976 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14977 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14978 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14979 parameters :
14980
14981 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14982 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14983
14984 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14985 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14986 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14987 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14988
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014989 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014990 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14991 seen as failed.
14992
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014993sni <expression>
14994 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14995 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14996 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14997 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014998 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14999 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015000 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015001 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15002 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015003
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015004source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015005source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015006source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015007 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15008 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15009 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15010 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15011
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015012 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15013 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15014 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15015 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15016 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15017 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15018 server.
15019
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015020 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15021 specifying the source address without port(s).
15022
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015023ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015024 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15025 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15026 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15027 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15028 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15029 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015030 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15031 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015032
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015033ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15034 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15035 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15036 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15037
15038ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15039 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15040 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15041 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15042
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015043ssl-reuse
15044 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15045 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15046 default value.
15047 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15048 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15049
15050stick
15051 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15052 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15053 default value.
15054 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15055 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015056
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015057socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015058 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015059 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15060 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15061
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015062tcp-ut <delay>
15063 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015064 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015065 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015066 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015067 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15068 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15069 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15070 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15071 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15072 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15073 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15074 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15075 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15076
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015077tfo
15078 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15079 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15080 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15081 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015082 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015083 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015085track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015086 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15087 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15088 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15089 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015090 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15091
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015092tls-tickets
15093 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15094 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15095 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015096 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15097 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15098 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015099 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015100 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015101
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015102verify [none|required]
15103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015104 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015105 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15106 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015107 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015108 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15109 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15110 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15111 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15112 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15113 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15114 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15115 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015116
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015117verifyhost <hostname>
15118 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015119 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15120 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15121 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15122 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15123 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15124 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15125 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15126 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015128weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015129 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15130 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15131 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015132 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15133 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15134 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15135 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15136 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15137 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015138
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015139ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15140 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15141 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15142 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15143
15144 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15145 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15146 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15147 server ALPN contains it.
15148
15149 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15150 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15151 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15152 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15153
15154 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15155 favor of the ALPN extension.
15156
15157 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15158
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015159
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151605.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15161-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015162
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015163HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15164using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015165configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015166This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15167can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15168workload.
15169This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15170resolution at run time.
15171Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15172carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15173
15174
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151755.3.1. Global overview
15176----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015177
15178As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15179different steps of the process life:
15180
15181 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15182 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15183 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15184
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015185 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15186 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015187
15188A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15189 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15190 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15191 resolution to know this new IP.
15192
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015193When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015194HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015195SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15196from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015197will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015198will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015199
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015200A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015201 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015202 first valid response.
15203
15204 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15205 servers return an error.
15206
15207
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152085.3.2. The resolvers section
15209----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210
15211This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015212HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15213contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015214
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015215When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15216uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15217is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15218answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15219
15220When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015221used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015222
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015223 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15224 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15225 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015226
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015227 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15228 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015229
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015230 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015231 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15232 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015233
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015234For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15235following scenarios are possible:
15236
15237 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15238 ignored
15239
15240 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15241 applied
15242
15243 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15244 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15245
15246 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15247 retries the query with a new type
15248
15249 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15250 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015251
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015252As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015253a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015254<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015255
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015256
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015257resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015258 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015259
15260A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15261
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015262accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015263 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015264 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015265 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15266 by RFC 6891)
15267
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015268 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15269 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15270 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15271 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15272 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15273 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015274
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015275nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15276 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15277 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15278 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15279 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15280 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15281 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15282 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15283 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15284 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015285 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15286
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015287parse-resolv-conf
15288 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15289 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15290 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15291
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015292hold <status> <period>
15293 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15294 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015295 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015296 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015297 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15298 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15299 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15300
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015301 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015302
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015303resolve_retries <nb>
15304 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15305 giving up.
15306 Default value: 3
15307
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015308 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15309 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15310 type.
15311
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015312timeout <event> <time>
15313 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15314 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15315 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015316 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15317 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015318 Default value: 1s
15319 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015320 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015321 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015322 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15323 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15324
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015325 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326
15327 resolvers mydns
15328 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15329 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015330 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015331 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015333 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015334 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015335 hold other 30s
15336 hold refused 30s
15337 hold nx 30s
15338 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015339 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015340 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015341
15342
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153436. Cache
15344---------
15345
15346HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15347(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15348RAM.
15349
15350The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15351this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15352
15353If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15354independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15355when we try to allocate a new one.
15356
15357The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15358
15359It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15360"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15361for more details.
15362
15363When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15364replaced by "<CACHE>".
15365
15366
153676.1. Limitation
15368----------------
15369
15370The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15371
15372- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015373- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15374 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15375 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015376- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15377- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015378- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15379 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15380 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015381- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15382 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015383- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15384 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15385 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015386
15387- If the request is not a GET
15388- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15389- If the request contains an Authorization header
15390
15391
153926.2. Setup
15393-----------
15394
15395To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15396the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15397
15398
153996.2.1. Cache section
15400---------------------
15401
15402cache <name>
15403 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15404 size of cache is mandatory.
15405
15406total-max-size <megabytes>
15407 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15408 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15409
15410max-object-size <bytes>
15411 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15412 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15413 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15414
15415max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015416 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015417 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15418 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15419 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15420 default.
15421
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015422process-vary <on/off>
15423 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015424 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15425 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15426 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015427 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015428
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015429max-secondary-entries <number>
15430 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15431 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15432 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15433
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015434
154356.2.2. Proxy section
15436---------------------
15437
15438http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15439 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15440 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15441 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15442 after this one.
15443
15444http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15445 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15446 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15447 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15448 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15449
15450
15451Example:
15452
15453 backend bck1
15454 mode http
15455
15456 http-request cache-use foobar
15457 http-response cache-store foobar
15458 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15459
15460 cache foobar
15461 total-max-size 4
15462 max-age 240
15463
15464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154657. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15466----------------------------------
15467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015468HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15470The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15471these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15472but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15473data called patterns.
15474
15475
154767.1. ACL basics
15477---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015478
15479The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15480content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15481from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15482simple :
15483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015485 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15487 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015488
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015489The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15490adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015491
15492In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015495
15496This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15497Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15498and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015499an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15500conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15501as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15502are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015503
15504ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15505'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15506which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15507
15508There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15509performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15512specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15513this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015514methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15515ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516
15517Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15518 - boolean
15519 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15520 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15521 - string
15522 - data block
15523
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015524Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15525converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15526would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15527The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15528which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15529
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015530Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15531keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15532fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15533which are summarized in the table below :
15534
15535 +---------------------+-----------------+
15536 | Sample or converter | Default |
15537 | output type | matching method |
15538 +---------------------+-----------------+
15539 | boolean | bool |
15540 +---------------------+-----------------+
15541 | integer | int |
15542 +---------------------+-----------------+
15543 | ip | ip |
15544 +---------------------+-----------------+
15545 | string | str |
15546 +---------------------+-----------------+
15547 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15548 +---------------------+-----------------+
15549
15550Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15551matching method, see below.
15552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15554 - boolean
15555 - integer or integer range
15556 - IP address / network
15557 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15558 - regular expression
15559 - hex block
15560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015561The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15562
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015563 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15564 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015566 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015567 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015568 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015569 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15572read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15573if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15574lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15575will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15576beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015577a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015578lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15579exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15580
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015581The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15582parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15583ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15584a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15585check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15586
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015587The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15588socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15589file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15592loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15593
15594 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15595
15596In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15597the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15598case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15599as well.
15600
15601The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15602sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15603do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15604methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15605is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015606obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15608default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15609that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15610string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15611
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015612The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15613By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15614string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15615resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015616server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015617waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015618flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15619function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15622sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15623be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015624
15625 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15626 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15628 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15629 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15630 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631
15632 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15633 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015635
15636 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015637 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015638
15639 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015640 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015641
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015642 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015643 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15644
15645 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15646 binary or string samples.
15647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15649 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15652 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15653 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15656 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15659 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15662 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15665 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015666 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15669 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15670 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015671
15672For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15673request, it is possible to do :
15674
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015675 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015676
15677In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15678buffer, one would use the following acl :
15679
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015680 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015681
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015682On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15683possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15684
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015685 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15688criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15689method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15690to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15691criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15692the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015695the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15696For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15699 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15700 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15701 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015702
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015703
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015704The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15705types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15706combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15707brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15708default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710 +-------------------------------------------------+
15711 | Input sample type |
15712 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015713 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015714 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15715 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15716 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015717 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015719 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015720 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015721 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015722 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015723 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015724 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015725 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015727 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015729 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015730 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015731 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015733 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015734 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015735 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015736 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015737 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015738 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15739 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15740 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015741
15742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157437.1.1. Matching booleans
15744------------------------
15745
15746In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15747Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15748When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15749that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15750
15751Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15752return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15753"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15754
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157567.1.2. Matching integers
15757------------------------
15758
15759Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15760enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15761to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15762
15763Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15764matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15765lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015766
15767For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15768unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15769representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15770
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015771As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15772two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15773instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15774ranges and operators.
15775
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015776For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015777operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15778Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15779of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015780
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015781Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015782
15783 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15784 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15785 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15786 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15787 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15788
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015789For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015790
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015791 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015792
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015793This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15794
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015795 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015796
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157987.1.3. Matching strings
15799-----------------------
15800
15801String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15802different forms :
15803
15804 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015805 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015806
15807 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015808 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015809
15810 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15811 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15812
15813 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15814 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15815
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015816 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15818 matches.
15819
15820 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15821 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15822 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
15824String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15825exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15826characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15827string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15828to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015829before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015830
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015831Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15832(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15833Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15834
15835Example:
15836 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15837 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15838
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158407.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15841---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015842
15843Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15844they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15845possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15846passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15847the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015848the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15849match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015850
15851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158527.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15853-------------------------------------
15854
15855It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15856not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15857a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15858to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15859digits may be used upper or lower case.
15860
15861Example :
15862 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015863 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015864
15865
158667.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15867---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015868
15869IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15870netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15871within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015872host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015873difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15874at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15875does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15876parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015877
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015878The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15879abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15880
15881 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15882 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15883 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15884 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15885 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15886 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15887 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15888 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15889
15890Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15891192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15892
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015893IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15894Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15895trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15896IPv6 patterns.
15897
15898HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15899following situations :
15900 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15901 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15902 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15903 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15904 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15905 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15906 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15907 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15908 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15909 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015911
159127.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15913----------------------------------
15914
15915Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15916combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15917
15918 - AND (implicit)
15919 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15920 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15927indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015929For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15930"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15931requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15932is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15933
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015934 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015935 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15936 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15937 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
15939To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15940and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15941
15942 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15943 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15944 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15945 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15946
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015947 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15949 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15950 use_backend www if host_www
15951
15952It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15953expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15954be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15955the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15956
15957 The following rule :
15958
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015959 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015960 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015961
15962 Can also be written that way :
15963
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015964 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965
15966It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15967to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15968simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15969sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15970good use is the following :
15971
15972 With named ACLs :
15973
15974 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15975 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15976 monitor fail if site_dead
15977
15978 With anonymous ACLs :
15979
15980 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15981
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015982See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15983keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984
15985
159867.3. Fetching samples
15987---------------------
15988
15989Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15990against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15991sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15992ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15993of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15994available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15995
15996This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15997Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15998compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15999deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16000
16001The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16002matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16003method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16004indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16005
16006As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16007when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16008mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16009the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16010ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16011
16012Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16013multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16014when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016015incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16016are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16018all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16019
16020Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16021 - name
16022 - name(arg1)
16023 - name(arg1,arg2)
16024
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016025
160267.3.1. Converters
16027-----------------
16028
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016029Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16030of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16031is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16032was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016033has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016034unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16035
16036These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16037sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16038the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016039support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016040
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016041A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16042support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16043supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16044(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16045bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016047The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016048
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16050 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16051 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16052 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16053 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16054 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16055
16056 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016057 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16058 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016059 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16060 frontend http-in
16061 bind *:8081
16062 default_backend servers
16063 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16064 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16065
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016066add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016067 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016068 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016069 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16070 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016071 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016072 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16073 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16074 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16075 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016076 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016077 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016078
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016079aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16080 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16081 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16082 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16083 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16084 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16085 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16086
16087 Example:
16088 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16089 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16090
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016091and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016092 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016093 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016094 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16095 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016096 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016097 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16098 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16099 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16100 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016101 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016102 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016103
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016104b64dec
16105 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16106 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016107 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16108 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016109
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016110base64
16111 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016113 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16114 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016115
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016116bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016117 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016118 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016119 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016120 presence of a flag).
16121
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016122bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16123 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16124 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016125 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016126
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016127concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16128 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16129 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16130 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16131 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16132 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16133 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16134 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16135 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16136 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16137 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016138 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016139 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016140 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16141 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016142
16143 Example:
16144 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16145 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16146 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016147 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016148 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16149
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016150cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016151 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16152 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016153
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016154crc32([<avalanche>])
16155 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16156 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16157 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16158 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16159 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16160 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16161 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16162 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16163 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16164 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016165 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16166
16167crc32c([<avalanche>])
16168 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16169 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16170 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16171 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16172 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16173 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16174 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16175 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016176
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016177cut_crlf
16178 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16179 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16180 updated.
16181
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016182da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016183 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16184 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16185 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16186 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016187 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016188 configuration language.
16189
16190 Example:
16191 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016192 bind *:8881
16193 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016194 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016195
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016196debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16197 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16198 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16199 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16200 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16201 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16202 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16203 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16204 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16205 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16206 printable sample types.
16207
16208 Example:
16209 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016210
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016211digest(<algorithm>)
16212 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16213 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16214
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016215 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016216 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16217
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016218div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016219 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16220 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016221 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016222 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16223 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016224 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016225 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16226 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16227 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16228 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016229 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016230 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016231
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016232djb2([<avalanche>])
16233 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16234 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16235 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16236 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16237 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16238 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16239 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016240 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16241 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016242
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016243even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016244 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016245 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16246
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016247field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16248 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16249 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16250 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16251 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16252 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16253 fields.
16254
16255 Example :
16256 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16257 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16258 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16259 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16260 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016261
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016262fix_is_valid
16263 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16264 Information eXchange):
16265
16266 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16267 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016268 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016269 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016270 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016271 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16272 checksum
16273
16274 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16275 the server can be parsed.
16276
16277 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16278 message, false if not.
16279
16280 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16281
16282 Example:
16283 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16284 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16285
16286fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16287 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16288 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16289 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16290 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016291 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016292 added.
16293
16294 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16295 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16296 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16297 fix_is_valid converter.
16298
16299 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16300
16301 Example:
16302 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16303 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16304 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16305 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16306 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16307
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016308hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016309 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016310 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016311 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016312 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016313
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016314hex2i
16315 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016316 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016317
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016318htonl
16319 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16320 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16321 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16322 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16323
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016324hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016325 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16326 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16327 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16328 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16329
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016330 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016331 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16332
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016333http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016334 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16335 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016336 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16337 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16338 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16339 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16340 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16341 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16342 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16343 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016344
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016345iif(<true>,<false>)
16346 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16347 string otherwise.
16348
16349 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016350 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016351
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016352in_table(<table>)
16353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16355 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016357 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16358
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016359ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016360 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016361 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016362 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16363 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16364 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16365 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16366 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016367
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016368json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016369 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016370 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016371 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016372 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16373 of errors:
16374 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16375 bytes, ...)
16376 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16377 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16378
16379 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16380 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16381 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16382 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16383 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16384 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016385 - "ascii" : never fails;
16386 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16387 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016388 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016389 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016390 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16391 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16392
16393 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016394 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016395
16396 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016397 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016398 capture request header user-agent len 150
16399 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016400
16401 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16402 GET / HTTP/1.0
16403 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16404
16405 Output log:
16406 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16407
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016408json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16409 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16410 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16411 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16412 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16413
16414 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16415 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16416
16417 Example:
16418 # get a integer value from the request body
16419 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16420 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16421
16422 # get a key with '.' in the name
16423 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16424 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16425
16426 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16427 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16428
16429 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16430 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16431
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016432language(<value>[,<default>])
16433 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16434 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16435 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16436 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16437 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16438 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16439 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16440 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16441 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016442 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016443 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16444 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016445
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016446 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016447
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016448 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16449 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016451 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16452 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16453 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16454 use_backend spanish if es
16455 use_backend french if fr
16456 use_backend english if en
16457 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016458
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016459length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016460 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16461 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16462 type. The result is of type integer.
16463
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016464lower
16465 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16466 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16467 type. The result is of type string.
16468
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016469ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16470 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16471 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16472 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16473 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16474 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16475 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16476
16477 Example :
16478
16479 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016480 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016481 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16482
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016483ltrim(<chars>)
16484 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16485 representation of the input sample.
16486
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016487map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16488map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16489map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16490 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16491 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16492 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16493 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16494 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16495 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16496 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16497 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016499 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16500 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16501 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016502
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016503 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016504 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016506 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16508 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16509 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016510 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16511 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016512 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16513 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16514 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16515 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16516 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16517 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16518 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16519 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016520 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16521 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16522 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016523 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16524 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16525 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16526 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16527 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016528
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016529 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16530 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16531 the corresponding match text.
16532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016533 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16534 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16535 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16536 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16537 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016539 Example :
16540
16541 # this is a comment and is ignored
16542 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16543 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16544 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16545 | | | `---------- value
16546 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16547 | `---------------------------- key
16548 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16549
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016550mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016551 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16552 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016553 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016554 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016555 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016556 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16557 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16558 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16559 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016560 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016561 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016562
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016563mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016564 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16565 <packettype>.
16566 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16567 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16568 from.
16569 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16570 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16571 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16572
16573 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16574 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16575 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16576 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16577
16578 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16579 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16580 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16581 packets only):
16582 17: Session Expiry Interval
16583 33: Receive Maximum
16584 39: Maximum Packet Size
16585 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16586 25: Request Response Information
16587 23: Request Problem Information
16588 21: Authentication Method
16589 22: Authentication Data
16590 18: Will Delay Interval
16591 1: Payload Format Indicator
16592 2: Message Expiry Interval
16593 3: Content Type
16594 8: Response Topic
16595 9: Correlation Data
16596 Not supported yet:
16597 38: User Property
16598
16599 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16600 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16601 packets only):
16602 17: Session Expiry Interval
16603 33: Receive Maximum
16604 36: Maximum QoS
16605 37: Retain Available
16606 39: Maximum Packet Size
16607 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16608 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16609 31: Reason String
16610 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16611 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16612 42: Shared Subscription Available
16613 19: Server Keep Alive
16614 26: Response Information
16615 28: Server Reference
16616 21: Authentication Method
16617 22: Authentication Data
16618 Not supported yet:
16619 38: User Property
16620
16621 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16622 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16623 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16624 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16625
16626 Example:
16627
16628 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16629 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16630 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16631 if data_in_buffer
16632 # do the same as above
16633 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16634 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16635 if data_in_buffer
16636
16637mqtt_is_valid
16638 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16639
16640 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16641 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16642 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16643 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16644
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016645 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16646
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016647 Example:
16648
16649 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016650 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016652mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016653 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016654 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16655 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016656 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016657 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016658 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016659 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16660 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16661 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16662 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016663 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016664 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016665
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016666nbsrv
16667 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16668 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16669 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16670 map lookup.
16671
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016672neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016673 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16674 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16675 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16676 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016677
16678not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016679 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016680 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016681 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016682 absence of a flag).
16683
16684odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016685 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016686 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16687
16688or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016689 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016690 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016691 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16692 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16696 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16697 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016698 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016699 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016700
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016701protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16702 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16703 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16704 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16705 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16706 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16707 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16708 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16709 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16710 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16711 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16712 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16713
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016714regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016715 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16716 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16717 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16718 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16719 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16720 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16721 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16722 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16723 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016724 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16725 of characters with other ones.
16726
16727 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16728 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16729 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16730 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16731 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16732 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016733
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016734 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016735
16736 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16737 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16738 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016739 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016740
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016741 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16742 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16743
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016744 # capture groups and backreferences
16745 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016746 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016747 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16748
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016749capture-req(<id>)
16750 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16751 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16752
16753 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016754 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16755 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016756
16757capture-res(<id>)
16758 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16759 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16760
16761 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016762 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16763 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016764
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016765rtrim(<chars>)
16766 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16767 of the input sample.
16768
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016769sdbm([<avalanche>])
16770 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16771 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16772 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16773 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16774 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16775 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16776 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016777 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16778 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016779
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016780secure_memcmp(<var>)
16781 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16782 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16783 match.
16784
16785 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16786 performed in constant time.
16787
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016788 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016789 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16790
16791 Example :
16792
16793 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16794 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16795 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16796 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16797
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016798set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016799 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16800 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16801 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016802 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016803 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16804 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016805 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016806 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16807 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016808 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016809 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016810
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016811sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016812 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016813 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16814
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016815sha2([<bits>])
16816 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16817 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16818
16819 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16820 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16821
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016822 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016823 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16824
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016825srv_queue
16826 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16827 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16828 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16829 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16830 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16831
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016832strcmp(<var>)
16833 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16834 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16835 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16836 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16837 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16838 shorter).
16839
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016840 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16841 strings in constant time.
16842
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016843 Example :
16844
16845 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16846 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16847 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16848
16849
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016850sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016851 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16852 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016853 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016854 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16855 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16858 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016859 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016864
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016865table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16869 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16870 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16871 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16872
16873
16874table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16878 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16879 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16880 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16881
16882table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016886 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16887 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16888
16889table_conn_cur(<table>)
16890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16893 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16894 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16895
16896table_conn_rate(<table>)
16897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16900 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16901 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16902
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016903table_gpt0(<table>)
16904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16907 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16908 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16909
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016910table_gpc0(<table>)
16911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16914 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16915 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16916
16917table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16921 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16922 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16923 sample fetch keyword.
16924
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016925table_gpc1(<table>)
16926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16929 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16930 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16931
16932table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16935 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16936 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16937 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16938 sample fetch keyword.
16939
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016940table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016944 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16945 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16946
16947table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16950 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16951 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16952 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16953 keyword.
16954
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016955table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16959 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16960 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16961
16962table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16965 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16966 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16967 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16968 keyword.
16969
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016970table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016974 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16975 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16976
16977table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16978 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16979 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16980 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16981 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16982 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16983 keyword.
16984
16985table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16986 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16987 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016988 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016989 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16990 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16991 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16992 keyword.
16993
16994table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16995 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16996 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016997 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016998 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16999 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17000 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17001 keyword.
17002
17003table_server_id(<table>)
17004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17007 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17008 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17009 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17010
17011table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017015 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17016 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17017 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17018 keyword.
17019
17020table_sess_rate(<table>)
17021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17024 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17025 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17026 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17027 keyword.
17028
17029table_trackers(<table>)
17030 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17031 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17032 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17033 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17034 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17035 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17036 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17037 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17038 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17039 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17040
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017041ub64dec
17042 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17043 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17044 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17045
17046 Example:
17047 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17048 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17049
17050ub64enc
17051 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17052
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017053upper
17054 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17055 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17056 type. The result is of type string.
17057
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017058url_dec([<in_form>])
17059 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17060 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17061 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17062 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17063 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17064 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017065
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017066url_enc([<enc_type>])
17067 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17068 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17069 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17070 optional argument is here for future changes.
17071
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017072ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017073 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017074 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17075 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17076 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017077 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17078 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17079 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17080 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017081 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017082 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17083 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017084
17085 Example:
17086 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17087 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17088
17089 message Point {
17090 int32 latitude = 1;
17091 int32 longitude = 2;
17092 }
17093
17094 message PPoint {
17095 Point point = 59;
17096 }
17097
17098 message Rectangle {
17099 // One corner of the rectangle.
17100 PPoint lo = 48;
17101 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17102 PPoint hi = 49;
17103 }
17104
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017105 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17106 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17107 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017108
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017109 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17110 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017111 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017112 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17113
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017114 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017115
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017116 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017117
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017118 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17119 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17120 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017121
17122 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17123 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17124 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17125
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017126 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17127 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17128 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017129
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017130
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017131unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017132 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17133 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17134 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17135 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17136 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17137 response),
17138 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17139 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17140 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17141 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17142
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017143utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17144 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17145 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17146 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17147 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17148 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17149 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17150
17151 Example :
17152
17153 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017154 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017155 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17156
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017157word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17158 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17159 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17160 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017161 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017162 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17163 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17164
17165 Example :
17166 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17167 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17168 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17169 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17170 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017171 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017172
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017173wt6([<avalanche>])
17174 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17175 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17176 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17177 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17178 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17179 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17180 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017181 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17182 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017183
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017184xor(<value>)
17185 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017186 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017187 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017188 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017189 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017190 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17191 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017192 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017193 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17194 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017195 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017196 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017197
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017198xxh3([<seed>])
17199 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17200 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17201 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17202 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17203 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17204 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17205 considered as cryptographically secure.
17206
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017207xxh32([<seed>])
17208 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17209 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17210 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17211 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17212 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17213 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17214 as cryptographically secure.
17215
17216xxh64([<seed>])
17217 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17218 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17219 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17220 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17221 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17222 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17223 as cryptographically secure.
17224
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017225
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172267.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017227--------------------------------------------
17228
17229A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17230not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17231"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17232The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17233
17234always_false : boolean
17235 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17236 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17237
17238always_true : boolean
17239 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17240 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17241
17242avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017243 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17245 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17246 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17247 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17248 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17249 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17250 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17251 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17252 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17253 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17254 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17255 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17256 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017258be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017259 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17260 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17261 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17262 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017263 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17264
17265be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17266 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17267 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17268 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17269 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17270 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017271 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17272 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017273
17274 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17275 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17276 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017278be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17279 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17280 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17281 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017282 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017283 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17284 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017285
17286 Example :
17287 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17288 backend dynamic
17289 mode http
17290 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17291 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017293bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017294 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17295 of the string.
17296
17297bool(<bool>) : bool
17298 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17299 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17302 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017303 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017304 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17305 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017306
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017307 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017308 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017309 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17310
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017311 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17312 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017313
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017314 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017315 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017316 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017317 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017318 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017319 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017320 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017321
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017322 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17323 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017324 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017325 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017326
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017327cpu_calls : integer
17328 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17329 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17330 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17331 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17332 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17333 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17334
17335cpu_ns_avg : integer
17336 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17337 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17338 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17339 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17340 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17341 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17342 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17343 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17344 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17345 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17346 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17347
17348cpu_ns_tot : integer
17349 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17350 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17351 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17352 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17353 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17354 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17355 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17356 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17357 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17358 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17359 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17360 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17361 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17362
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017363date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017364 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017365
17366 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17367 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17368 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017369 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17370
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017371 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17372 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17373 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17374 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17375 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17376
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017377 Example :
17378
17379 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17380 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017381
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017382 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17383 # millisecond granularity
17384 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17385
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017386date_us : integer
17387 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17388 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17389 from the same timeval structure.
17390
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017391distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17392 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17393 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17394 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17395 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017396 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017397 list of supported tokens.
17398
17399distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17400 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17401 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17402 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17403 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017404 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017405 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17406 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17407 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17408 supported tokens.
17409
17410 Example :
17411 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17412 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17413 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17414 # send large files to the big farm
17415 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17416
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017417env(<name>) : string
17418 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17419 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17420 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17421 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17422 certain way.
17423
17424 Examples :
17425 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17426 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17427
17428 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017429 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17432 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017433 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17434 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017435 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17436 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017437 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017438 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17439 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017440
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017441fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17442 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17443 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17444 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017446fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17447 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17448 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17449 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17450 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17451 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17452 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17453 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17454 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017455
17456 Example :
17457 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17458 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17459 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17460 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17461 frontend mail
17462 bind :25
17463 mode tcp
17464 maxconn 100
17465 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17466 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17467 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17468 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017469
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017470hostname : string
17471 Returns the system hostname.
17472
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017473int(<integer>) : signed integer
17474 Returns a signed integer.
17475
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017476ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17477 Returns an ipv4.
17478
17479ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17480 Returns an ipv6.
17481
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017482lat_ns_avg : integer
17483 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17484 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17485 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17486 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17487 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17488 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17489 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17490 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17491 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017492 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17493 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17494 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17495 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17496 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17497 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017498
17499lat_ns_tot : integer
17500 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17501 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17502 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17503 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17504 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17505 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17506 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17507 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17508 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017509 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17510 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17511 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17512 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17513 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017514 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17515 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17516 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17517 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17518 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17519 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17520
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017521meth(<method>) : method
17522 Returns a method.
17523
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017524nbproc : integer
17525 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17526 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17527 and debugging purposes.
17528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017529nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17530 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17531 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17532 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017533 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17534 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17535 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017536
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017537prio_class : integer
17538 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17539 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17540 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17541
17542prio_offset : integer
17543 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17544 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17545 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17546 set-priority-offset".
17547
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017548proc : integer
17549 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17550 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17551 debugging purposes.
17552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017553queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017554 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17555 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17556 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017557 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17558 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17559 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17560 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17561 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17562
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017563rand([<range>]) : integer
17564 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17565 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17566 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17567 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17568 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017570srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17572 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17573 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17574 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17575 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017576 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17577 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17578
17579srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17580 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17581 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17582 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17583 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17584 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17585 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17586 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17587
17588 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17589 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017590
17591srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17592 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17593 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17594 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017595 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17597 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17598 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17599
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017600srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17601 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17602 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17603 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17604 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17605 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17606 fetch methods.
17607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17609 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17610 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017611 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17613 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017614 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 overloading servers).
17616
17617 Example :
17618 # Redirect to a separate back
17619 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17620 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17621 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17622
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017623srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017624 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17625 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17626 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17627
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017628srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017629 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17630 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17631 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17632
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017633srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017634 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17635 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17636 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17637
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017638stopping : boolean
17639 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17640 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17641 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17642
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017643str(<string>) : string
17644 Returns a string.
17645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017646table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17647 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17648 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17649
17650table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17651 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17652 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17653 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17654
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017655thread : integer
17656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17657 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17658 and debugging purposes.
17659
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017660uuid([<version>]) : string
17661 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17662 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17663 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17664
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017665var(<var-name>) : undefined
17666 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017667 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17668 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17671 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017672 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017673 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17674 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017675 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017676 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017677
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176787.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017679----------------------------------
17680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017681The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17683methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17684sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17685TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017686the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17687counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017688"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17689used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17690can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17691Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17692table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17693tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17694currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017695
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017696bc_dst : ip
17697 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17698 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17699 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17700 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17701
17702bc_dst_port : integer
17703 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017704 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017705
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017706bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017707 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17708 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17709 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17710
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017711bc_src : ip
17712 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017713 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017714 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17715 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17716
17717bc_src_port : integer
17718 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017719 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721be_id : integer
17722 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017723 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17724 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017725
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017726be_name : string
17727 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017728 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17729 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017730
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017731be_server_timeout : integer
17732 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17733 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17734 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17735
17736be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17737 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17738 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17739 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17740
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017741cur_server_timeout : integer
17742 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17743 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17744 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17745
17746cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17747 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17748 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17749 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017751dst : ip
17752 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17753 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17754 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17755 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017756 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17757 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17758 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17759 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17760 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17761 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017762
17763dst_conn : integer
17764 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17765 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17766 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17767 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17768 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17769 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17770 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17771 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017772
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017773dst_is_local : boolean
17774 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17775 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17776 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17777 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017778 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017779 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17780 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17781 it only once per connection.
17782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017783dst_port : integer
17784 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17785 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17786 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17787 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17788 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17789 an HTTP header.
17790
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017791fc_fackets : integer
17792 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17793 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17794 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17795 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17796
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017797fc_http_major : integer
17798 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17799 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17800 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17801
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017802fc_lost : integer
17803 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17804 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17805 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17806 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17807
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017808fc_pp_authority : string
17809 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17810 if any.
17811
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017812fc_pp_unique_id : string
17813 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17814 if any.
17815
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017816fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17817 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17818 header.
17819
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017820fc_reordering : integer
17821 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17822 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17823 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17824 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17825
17826fc_retrans : integer
17827 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17828 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17829 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17830 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17831
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017832fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17833 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17834 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17835 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17836 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17837 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17838 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17839
17840fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17841 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17842 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17843 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17844 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17845 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17846 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17847
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017848fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017849 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17850 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17851 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17852 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17853
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017854
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017855fc_unacked : integer
17856 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17857 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17858 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17859 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017860
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017861fe_defbe : string
17862 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17863 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865fe_id : integer
17866 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017867 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017868 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17869
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017870fe_name : string
17871 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17872 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17873 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17874
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017875fe_client_timeout : integer
17876 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17877 current frontend.
17878
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017879sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017880sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17881sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17882sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017883 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17884 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17885 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17886
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017887sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017888sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17889sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17890sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017891 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17892 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17893 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17894
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017895sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017896sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17897sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17898sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017899 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17900 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017901 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17902 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17903 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017904
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017905 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017906 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17907 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017908 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17909 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17910 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017911 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17912 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17913
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017914sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17915sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17916sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17917sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17918 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17919 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17920 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17921 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17922 when a first ACL was verified.
17923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017924sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017925sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17926sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17927sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017928 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017929 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17930
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017931sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017932sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17933sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17934sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017935 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17936 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17937 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17938
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017939sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017940sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17941sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17942sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017943 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17944 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17945 See also src_conn_rate.
17946
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017947sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017948sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17949sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17950sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017951 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017952 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017953
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017954sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17955sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17956sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17957sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17958 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17959 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17960
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017961sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17962sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17963sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17964sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17965 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17966 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17967
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017968sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017969sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17970sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17971sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017972 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17973 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17974 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017975 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17976 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17977 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017978
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017979sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17980sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17981sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17982sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17983 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17984 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17985 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17986 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17987 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17988 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17989
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017990sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017991sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17992sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17993sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017994 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017995 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17996 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17997
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017998sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017999sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18000sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18001sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018002 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18003 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18004 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18005 src_http_err_rate.
18006
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018007sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18008sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18009sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18010sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18011 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18012 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18013 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18014
18015sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18016sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18017sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18018sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18019 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18020 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18021 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18022 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18023
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018024sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018025sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18026sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18027sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018028 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018029 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18030 src_http_req_cnt.
18031
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018032sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018033sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18034sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18035sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018036 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18037 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18038 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18039 src_http_req_rate.
18040
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018041sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018042sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18043sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18044sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018045 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018046 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18047 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18048 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18049 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018050
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018051 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018052 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18053 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018054 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18055
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018056sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18057sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18058sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18059sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18060 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18061 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18062 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18063 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18064 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18065
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018066sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018067sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18068sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18069sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018070 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18071 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18072 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018074sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018075sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18076sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18077sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018078 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18079 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18080 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018082sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018083sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18084sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18085sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018086 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018087 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18088 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18089 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018090 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018091 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018093sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018094sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18095sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18096sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018097 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18098 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18099 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18100 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18101 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018102 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018104sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018105sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18106sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18107sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018108 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18109 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18110 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18111
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018112sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018113sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18114sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18115sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018116 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18117 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018118 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018119 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18120 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018121 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18122 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18123 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018125so_id : integer
18126 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18127 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18128 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018129
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018130so_name : string
18131 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18132 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18133 strings instead of integers.
18134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018135src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018136 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018137 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18138 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18139 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018140 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18141 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18142 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018143 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18144 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18145 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18146 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18147 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18148 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18149 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018150
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018151 Example:
18152 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18153 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018155src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18156 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18157 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18158 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018159 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018161src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18162 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18163 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018164 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018165 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18168 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18169 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18170 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18171 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18172 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18173 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018174
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018175 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018176 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18177 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18178 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18179 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018180 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018181 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18182 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18183
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018184src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18185 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18186 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18187 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18188 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18189 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18190 was verified.
18191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018192src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018193 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018194 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018195 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018196 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018199 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018200 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18201 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018202 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18205 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18206 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18207 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018208 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018211 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018212 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018213 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018214 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018215
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018216src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18217 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18218 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18219 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18220 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18221
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018222src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18223 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18224 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18225 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18226 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018228src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018229 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018230 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018231 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18232 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018233 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18234 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18235 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018236
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018237src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18238 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18239 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18240 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18241 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18242 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18243 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18244 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018247 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018248 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018249 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018250 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018251 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018253src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18254 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18255 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18256 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18257 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018258 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018259
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018260src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18261 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18262 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018263 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018264 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18265 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18266
18267src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18268 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18269 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18270 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18271 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18272 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18273 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018276 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018277 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18278 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018279 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18282 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18283 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18284 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018285 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018286 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018288src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18289 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18290 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18291 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018292 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018293 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18294 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018295
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018296 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018297 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018298 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018299 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018300
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018301src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18302 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18303 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18304 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18305 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18306 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18307 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18308
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018309src_is_local : boolean
18310 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18311 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18312 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18313 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018314 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018315 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18316 once per connection.
18317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018319 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18320 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18321 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18322 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18323 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018326 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18327 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18328 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18329 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18330 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332src_port : integer
18333 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18334 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18335 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18336 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018339 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018340 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18341 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18342 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018343 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18346 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18347 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18348 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18349 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018350 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18353 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18354 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18355 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18356 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18357 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18358 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18359 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18360 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018361
18362 Example :
18363 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18364 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18365 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18366 listen ssh
18367 bind :22
18368 mode tcp
18369 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018370 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018371 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018372 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018374srv_id : integer
18375 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18376 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018377 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018378
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018379srv_name : string
18380 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18381 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018382 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018383
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183847.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018385----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018386
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018387The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18389when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18390usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018391future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018392
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001839351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18394 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18395 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18396 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18397 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18398 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18399
18400 Example :
18401 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18402 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18403 # the request.
18404 frontend http-in
18405 bind *:8081
18406 default_backend servers
18407 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18408 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18409
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018410ssl_bc : boolean
18411 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18412 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018413 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18414 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018415
18416ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18417 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018418 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18419 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018420
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018421ssl_bc_alpn : string
18422 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18423 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018424 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018425 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18426 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18427 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18428 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18429 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018430 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18431 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018432
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018433ssl_bc_cipher : string
18434 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018435 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18436 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018437
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018438ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18439 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18440 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18441 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018442 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018443
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018444ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18445 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18446 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018447 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18448 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018449
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018450ssl_bc_npn : string
18451 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18452 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018453 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018454 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18455 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18456 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18457 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018458 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18459 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018460
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018461ssl_bc_protocol : string
18462 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018463 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18464 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018465
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018466ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018467 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018468 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018469 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18470 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018471
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018472ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18473 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18474 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18475 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018476 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018477
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018478ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18479 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18480 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018481 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18482 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018483
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018484ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18485 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18486 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18487 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018488 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018489
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018490ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18491 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018492 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18493 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18496 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18497 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18498 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18499 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18500 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018502ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18503 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18504 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18505 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18506 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018507
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018508ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018509 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18510 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18511 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018512 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018513 does not support resumed sessions.
18514
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018515ssl_c_der : binary
18516 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18517 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18518 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018520ssl_c_err : integer
18521 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18522 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18523 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18524 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18525 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018526
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018527ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018528 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18529 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18530 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18531 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18532 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18533 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18534 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18535 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018536 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18537 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18538 LDAP v3.
18539 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18540 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018542ssl_c_key_alg : string
18543 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18544 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18545 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018547ssl_c_notafter : string
18548 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18549 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18550 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018552ssl_c_notbefore : string
18553 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18554 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18555 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018556
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018557ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018558 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18559 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18560 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18561 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18562 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18563 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18564 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18565 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018566 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18567 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18568 LDAP v3.
18569 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18570 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572ssl_c_serial : binary
18573 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18574 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18575 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018577ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18578 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18579 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18580 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018581 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18582 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18583
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018584 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018585 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018587ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18588 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18589 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18590 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592ssl_c_used : boolean
18593 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18594 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018596ssl_c_verify : integer
18597 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18598 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18599 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18600 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018602ssl_c_version : integer
18603 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18604 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018605
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018606ssl_f_der : binary
18607 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18608 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18609 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18610
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018611ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018612 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18613 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18614 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18615 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018616 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018617 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18618 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18619 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018620 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18621 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18622 LDAP v3.
18623 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18624 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018626ssl_f_key_alg : string
18627 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18628 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18629 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018631ssl_f_notafter : string
18632 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18633 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18634 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018636ssl_f_notbefore : string
18637 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18638 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18639 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018640
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018641ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018642 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18643 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18644 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18645 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18646 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18647 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18648 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18649 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018650 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18651 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18652 LDAP v3.
18653 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18654 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018656ssl_f_serial : binary
18657 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18658 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18659 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018660
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018661ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18662 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18663 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18664 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18665
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018666ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18667 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18668 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18669 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018671ssl_f_version : integer
18672 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18673 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18674
18675ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018676 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18677 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18678 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018680 Example :
18681 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18682 listen http-https
18683 bind :80
18684 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18685 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18686
18687ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18688 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18689 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18690
18691ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018692 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018694 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018695 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18696 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18697 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18698 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18699 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18700 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702ssl_fc_cipher : string
18703 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18704 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018705
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018706ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18707 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18708 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018709 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018710
18711ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18712 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18713 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018714 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018715
18716ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18717 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18718 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18719 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018720 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018721 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018722
18723ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18724 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18725 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018726 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018727
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018728ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18729 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18730 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18731 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18732
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018733ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18734 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18735 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18736 transport layer.
18737 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18738 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18739 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18740 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18741
18742ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18743 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18744 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18745 transport layer.
18746 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18747 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18748 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18749 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18750
18751ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18752 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18753 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18754 transport layer.
18755 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18756 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18757 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18758 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18759
18760ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18761 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18762 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18763 transport layer.
18764 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18765 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18766 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18767 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18768
18769ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18770 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18771 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18772 transport layer.
18773 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18774 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18775 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18776 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018778ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018779 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18780 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018781 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18782 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18783 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18784 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018785
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018786ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18787 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18788 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18789 wait until the handshake happened.
18790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018791ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18792 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018793 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18794 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018795 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018796 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018797
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018798ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018799 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018800 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18801 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018803ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018804 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018805 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18807 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18808 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18809 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18810 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18811 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018813ssl_fc_protocol : string
18814 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18815 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018816
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018817ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018818 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018819 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018820 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018821
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018822ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18823 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18824 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18825 transport layer.
18826 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18827 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18828 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18829 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18830
18831ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18832 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18833 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18834 transport layer.
18835 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18836 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18837 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18838 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18839
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018840ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18841 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18842 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18843 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018845ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18846 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18847 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18848 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18849 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018850
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018851ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18852 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18853 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18854 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18855 BoringSSL.
18856
18857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858ssl_fc_sni : string
18859 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18860 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018861 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018862 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18863 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18864
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018865 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018866 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018868 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018869 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18873 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018875ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18876 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18877 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018878
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018879ssl_s_der : binary
18880 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18881 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18882 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18883
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018884ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18885 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18886 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18887 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018888 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018889 does not support resumed sessions.
18890
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018891ssl_s_key_alg : string
18892 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18893 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18894 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18895
18896ssl_s_notafter : string
18897 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18898 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18899 transport layer.
18900
18901ssl_s_notbefore : string
18902 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18903 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18904 transport layer.
18905
18906ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18907 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18908 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18909 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18910 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18911 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18912 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018913 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18914 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018915 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18916 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18917 LDAP v3.
18918 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18919 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18920
18921ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18922 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18923 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18924 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18925 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18926 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18927 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018928 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18929 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018930 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18931 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18932 LDAP v3.
18933 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18934 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18935
18936ssl_s_serial : binary
18937 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18938 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18939 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18940
18941ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18942 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18943 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18944 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18945
18946ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18947 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18948 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18949 layer.
18950
18951ssl_s_version : integer
18952 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18953 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018954
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189557.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018956------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018958Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18959sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18960only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18961For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18962be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18963can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18964sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18965for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18966content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018967
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018968Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18969 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018970 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018971 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18972 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18973 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18974 sample expression). So be careful.
18975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018976payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018977 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018978 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18979 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018981payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18982 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018983 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018984 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018986req.len : integer
18987req_len : integer (deprecated)
18988 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18989 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18990 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18991 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18992 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018993 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018994 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18995 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18998 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018999 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19000 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19001 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19002 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019003
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019004 ACL derivatives :
19005 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019007req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19008 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19009 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19010 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19011 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019012
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019013 ACL derivatives :
19014 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019016 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019018req.proto_http : boolean
19019req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19020 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19021 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19022 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19023 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19024 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19025 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19026 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019028 Example:
19029 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19030 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19031 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019032 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19035rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19036 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19037 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19038 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19039 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19040 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19041 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19042 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19045 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19046 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19047 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19048 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19049 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019051 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019052 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019054 Example :
19055 listen tse-farm
19056 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19057 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19058 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19059 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19060 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19061 persist rdp-cookie
19062 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19063 # This is only useful makes sense if
19064 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19065 stick-table type string size 204800
19066 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19067 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19068 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019071 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19074rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19075 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19076 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19077 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19078 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019080 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019081 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019082
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019083req.ssl_alpn : string
19084 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19085 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19086 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19087 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19088 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19089 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019090 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019091
19092 Examples :
19093 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19094 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019095 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019096 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019097 default_backend bk_default
19098
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019099req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19100 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19101 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019102 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19103 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19104 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19105 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19106 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19109req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19110 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19111 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19112 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19113 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19114 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19115 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19116 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118req.ssl_sni : string
19119req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19120 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19121 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19122 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19123 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19124 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019125 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19126 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19127 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19128 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19129 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19130 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19131 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19132 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19133 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019135 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019136 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138 Examples :
19139 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19140 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019141 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019142 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019144
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019145req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19146 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19147 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19148 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19149 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19150 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19151 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19152 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19153 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19154 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019156req.ssl_ver : integer
19157req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19158 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19159 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19160 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19161 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19162 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19163 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19164 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019165 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019166 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019169 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019170
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019171res.len : integer
19172 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19173 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19174 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19175 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19176 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019177 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019178 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019179 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019181res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19182 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019183 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019184 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019185 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019186 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019188res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19189 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19190 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19191 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019192 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19193 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019196
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019197res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19198rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19199 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19200 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19201 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19202 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19203 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19204 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19205 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019207wait_end : boolean
19208 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19209 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019210 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19212 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019213 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019214 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19215 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019217 Examples :
19218 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19219 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19220 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19223 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19224 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19225 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19226 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19227 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19228 tcp-request content reject
19229
19230
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192317.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232--------------------------------------
19233
19234It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19235This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19236data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19237its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19238HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19239content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19240to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19241more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19242response are indexed.
19243
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019244Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19245 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19246 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19247 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19248 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19249 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19250 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019252base : string
19253 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19254 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19255 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19256 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19257 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19258 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19259 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19260 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19261
19262 ACL derivatives :
19263 base : exact string match
19264 base_beg : prefix match
19265 base_dir : subdir match
19266 base_dom : domain match
19267 base_end : suffix match
19268 base_len : length match
19269 base_reg : regex match
19270 base_sub : substring match
19271
19272base32 : integer
19273 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19274 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19275 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019276 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19277 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19278 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019279
19280base32+src : binary
19281 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19282 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19283 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19284 per-URL counters.
19285
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019286baseq : string
19287 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19288 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19289 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19290 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19291
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019292capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19293 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19294 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19295 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19296
19297capture.req.method : string
19298 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19299 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19300 because it's allocated.
19301
19302capture.req.uri : string
19303 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19304 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19305 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19306 allocated.
19307
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019308capture.req.ver : string
19309 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19310 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19311 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19312
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019313capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19314 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19315 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19316 The first entry is an index of 0.
19317 See also: "capture response header"
19318
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019319capture.res.ver : string
19320 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19321 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19322 persistent flag.
19323
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019324req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019325 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19326 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19327 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019328
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019329req.body_param([<name>) : string
19330 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19331 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19332 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19333 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19334 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19335 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19336 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19337 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19338 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19339 given.
19340
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019341req.body_len : integer
19342 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19343 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019344 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19345 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019346
19347req.body_size : integer
19348 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019349 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19350 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352req.cook([<name>]) : string
19353cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19354 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19355 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19356 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19357 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19358 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19359 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19360 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19361 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19362
19363 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019364 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19365 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19366 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19367 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19368 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19369 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19370 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19371 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019373req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19374cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19375 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19376 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019378req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19379cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19380 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19381 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19382 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19383 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019385cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19386 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19387 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19388 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19389 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019390 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019391 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19392 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19393 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19394 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19397 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19398 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19399 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19400 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019401 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019404 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19405 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19406 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19407 with headers such as User-Agent.
19408
19409 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19410 found.
19411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019412 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19413 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19414 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019415 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019417req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19418 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19419 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019420 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19421 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019423req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019424 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19425 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19426 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19427 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19428 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19429 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19430 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19431
19432 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19433 found.
19434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19436 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19437 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019438 with -1 being the last one.
19439
19440 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19441 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019443 ACL derivatives :
19444 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19445 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19446 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19447 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19448 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19449 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19450 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19451 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19452
19453req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19454hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19455 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19456 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019457 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19458 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19459 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19460
19461 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19462 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19463 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19464
19465 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019466
19467req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19468hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19469 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19470 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19471 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019472 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19473 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19474 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19475 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19476 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019477
19478 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19479
19480 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481
19482req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19483hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19484 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19485 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19486 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019487
19488 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19489
19490 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019491
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019492req.hdrs : string
19493 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19494 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19495 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19496 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19497
19498req.hdrs_bin : binary
19499 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19500 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19501 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19502 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19503 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19504 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19505
19506 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019507
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019508 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19509 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019511http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19512 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19513 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19514 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19515 basic auth is supported.
19516
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019517http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19518 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19519 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19520 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19521 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019522 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19523 basic auth is supported.
19524
19525 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019526 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19527 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19528 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19529 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019531http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019532 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19533 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19534 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019535
19536http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019537 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19538 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19539 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019540
19541http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019542 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19543 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19544 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019546http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019547 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19548 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019549 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19550 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019552method : integer + string
19553 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19554 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19555 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19556 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19557 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19558 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19559 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019561 ACL derivatives :
19562 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019564 Example :
19565 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19566 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19567 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569path : string
19570 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19571 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19572 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19573 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19574 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019575 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019576 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019577
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019578 ACL derivatives :
19579 path : exact string match
19580 path_beg : prefix match
19581 path_dir : subdir match
19582 path_dom : domain match
19583 path_end : suffix match
19584 path_len : length match
19585 path_reg : regex match
19586 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019587
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019588pathq : string
19589 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19590 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19591 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19592 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19593 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19594 result in both cases.
19595
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019596query : string
19597 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19598 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19599 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19600 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019601 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019602 which stops before the question mark.
19603
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019604req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19605 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19606 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19607 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19608 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019610req.ver : string
19611req_ver : string (deprecated)
19612 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19613 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19614 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019616 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019617 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019618
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019619res.body : binary
19620 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19621 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019622 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19623
19624 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019625
19626res.body_len : integer
19627 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19628 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019629 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19630
19631 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019632
19633res.body_size : integer
19634 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19635 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19636 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19637 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019638 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19639
19640 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019641
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019642res.cache_hit : boolean
19643 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19644 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19645
19646res.cache_name : string
19647 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19648 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19649 empty string.
19650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019651res.comp : boolean
19652 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19653 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19654 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019655
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019656res.comp_algo : string
19657 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19658 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19659 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019661res.cook([<name>]) : string
19662scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19663 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19664 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019665 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19666
19667 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019670 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019672res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19673scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19674 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19675 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019676 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19677
19678 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019680res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19681scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19682 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19683 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019684 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19685
19686 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019689 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19690 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19691
19692 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19693 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19694
19695 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19696
19697 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019699res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019700 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19701 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19702
19703 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19704 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19705
19706 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19709shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019710 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19711 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19712
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019713 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019714 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19715
19716 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019718 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019719 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19720 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19721 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19722 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19723 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19724 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19725 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19726 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019727
19728res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19729shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019730 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19731 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19732
19733 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019734 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019735
19736 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019738res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19739shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019740 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19741 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19742
19743 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19744
19745 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019746
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019747res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19748 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19749 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19750 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019751 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19752
19753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19756shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019757 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19758 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19759
19760 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19761
19762 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019763
19764res.hdrs : string
19765 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19766 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19767 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019768 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19769
19770 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019771
19772res.hdrs_bin : binary
19773 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19774 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19775 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19776 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19777 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19778 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19779 (length of 0 for both).
19780
19781 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19782
19783 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19784 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019786res.ver : string
19787resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19788 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019789 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19790
19791 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019794 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019796set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19797 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19798 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019799 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019800 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019802 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19803 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019805status : integer
19806 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19807 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019808 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19809
19810 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019811
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019812unique-id : string
19813 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19814 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19815 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19816 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19817 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19818 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019820url : string
19821 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19822 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19823 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19824 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19825 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19826 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19827 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019829 ACL derivatives :
19830 url : exact string match
19831 url_beg : prefix match
19832 url_dir : subdir match
19833 url_dom : domain match
19834 url_end : suffix match
19835 url_len : length match
19836 url_reg : regex match
19837 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019839url_ip : ip
19840 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19841 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19842 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19843 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19844 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19845 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19846 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848url_port : integer
19849 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19850 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19851 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19852 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019853
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019854urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19855url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019856 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19857 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019858 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19859 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19860 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19861 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019862 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19863 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019864 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19865 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019867 ACL derivatives :
19868 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19869 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19870 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19871 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19872 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19873 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19874 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19875 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019876
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019878 Example :
19879 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19880 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19881 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19882 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019883
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019884urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19886 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19887 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019888
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019889url32 : integer
19890 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19891 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19892 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19893 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19894 is an unsigned integer.
19895
19896url32+src : binary
19897 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19898 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19899 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19900
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019901
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199027.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019903---------------------------------------
19904
19905This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19906used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19907purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19908There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19909or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19910any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19911for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19912
19913internal.htx.data : integer
19914 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19915 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19916
19917internal.htx.free : integer
19918 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19919 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19920
19921internal.htx.free_data : integer
19922 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19923 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19924
19925internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019926 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19927 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19928 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019929
19930internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19931 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19932 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19933
19934internal.htx.size : integer
19935 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19936 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19937
19938internal.htx.used : integer
19939 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19940 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19941 direction.
19942
19943internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19944 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19945 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19946 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19947 of the special value :
19948 * head : The oldest inserted block
19949 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019950 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019951
19952internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19953 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19954 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19955 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19956 integer or one of the special value :
19957 * head : The oldest inserted block
19958 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019959 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019960
19961internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19962 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19963 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19964 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19965 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19966
19967 * head : The oldest inserted block
19968 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019969 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019970
19971internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19972 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19973 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19974 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19975 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19976
19977 * head : The oldest inserted block
19978 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019979 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019980
19981internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19982 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19983 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19984 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19985 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19986
19987 * head : The oldest inserted block
19988 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019989 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019990
19991internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19992 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19993 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19994 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19995 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19996
19997 * head : The oldest inserted block
19998 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019999 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020000
20001internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20002 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20003 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20004 it returns false.
20005
20006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200077.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020008---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020009
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020010Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20011every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020012order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020014ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020015---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20016FALSE always_false never match
20017HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20018HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20019HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020020HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020021HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20022HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20023HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20024HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20025LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20026METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20027METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20028METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20029METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20030METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20031METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20032METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20033METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20034RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20035REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20036TRUE always_true always match
20037WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20038---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020039
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200418. Logging
20042----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020043
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020044One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20045provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20046very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20047provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20048state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020049to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020050headers.
20051
20052In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20053about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20054send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20055
20056 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20057 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20058 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20059 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20060 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020061 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020062 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020063
20064The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20065allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20066as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20067while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20068real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20069delay.
20070
20071
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200728.1. Log levels
20073---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020074
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020075TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020076source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020077HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20078in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20079track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20080syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20081about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020082
20083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200848.2. Log formats
20085----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020086
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020087HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020088and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20089slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20090options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020091
20092 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20093 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20094 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20095 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20096 extents.
20097
20098 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20099 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20100 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20101 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20102 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20103
20104 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20105 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20106 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20107 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20108 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20109
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020110 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20111 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20112 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20113 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20114
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020115 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20116
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020117Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20118specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20119field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20120servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20121always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20122identifier.
20123
20124Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20125 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20126 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20127 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20128 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20129
20130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201318.2.1. Default log format
20132-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020133
20134This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20135as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20136format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20137
20138 Example :
20139 listen www
20140 mode http
20141 log global
20142 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20143
20144 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20145 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20146 (www/HTTP)
20147
20148 Field Format Extract from the example above
20149 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20150 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20151 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20152 4 'to' to
20153 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20154 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20155
20156Detailed fields description :
20157 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20158 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20159 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20160 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20161 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20162 and processed the connection.
20163 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20164
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020165In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20166"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20167connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20168
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020169It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20170will eventually disappear.
20171
20172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201738.2.2. TCP log format
20174---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020175
20176The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20177is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20178information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20179counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20180emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20181environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20182the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20183sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020184specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20185not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20186fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20187marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020188
20189 Example :
20190 frontend fnt
20191 mode tcp
20192 option tcplog
20193 log global
20194 default_backend bck
20195
20196 backend bck
20197 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20198
20199 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20200 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20201 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20202
20203 Field Format Extract from the example above
20204 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20205 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20206 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20207 4 frontend_name fnt
20208 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20209 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20210 7 bytes_read* 212
20211 8 termination_state --
20212 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20213 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20214
20215Detailed fields description :
20216 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020217 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020218 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20219 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020220 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020221 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020222 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223
20224 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020225 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20226 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20227 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020229 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020230 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20231 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020232 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20233 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20234 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20235 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
20237 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20238 and processed the connection.
20239
20240 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20241 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20242 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20243 applications.
20244
20245 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20246 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20247 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20248 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20249 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20250
20251 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20252 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20253 See "Timers" below for more details.
20254
20255 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20256 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20257 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20258 "Timers" below for more details.
20259
20260 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020261 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020262 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20263 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20264 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20265 details.
20266
20267 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20268 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20269 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20270 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20271 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20272
20273 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20274 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20275 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20276 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20277 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20278 for more details.
20279
20280 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020281 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020282 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20283 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20284 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020285 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020286
20287 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20288 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20289 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20290 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20291 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20292 caused by a denial of service attack.
20293
20294 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20295 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20296 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20297 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20298 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20299 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20300 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20301 denial of service attack.
20302
20303 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20304 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20305 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20306 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20307 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20308 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20309 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20310 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20311 be processed than on other servers.
20312
20313 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20314 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20315 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20316 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020317 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020318 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20319 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20320 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20321 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20322 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20323 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20324 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20325 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20326
20327 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20328 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20329 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20330 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20331 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20332 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020333 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020334 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20335
20336 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20337 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20338 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20339 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20340 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20341 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020342 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20344 occurs.
20345
20346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203478.2.3. HTTP log format
20348----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020349
20350The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20351is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20352the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20353are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20354emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20355generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20356"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20357which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020358frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20359is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020360
20361Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20362slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20363with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20364
20365 Example :
20366 frontend http-in
20367 mode http
20368 option httplog
20369 log global
20370 default_backend bck
20371
20372 backend static
20373 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20374
20375 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20376 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20377 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020378 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020379
20380 Field Format Extract from the example above
20381 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20382 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020383 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020384 4 frontend_name http-in
20385 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020386 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020387 7 status_code 200
20388 8 bytes_read* 2750
20389 9 captured_request_cookie -
20390 10 captured_response_cookie -
20391 11 termination_state ----
20392 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20393 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20394 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20395 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20396 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020397
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020398Detailed fields description :
20399 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020400 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020401 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20402 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020403 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020404 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020405 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020406
20407 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020408 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20409 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20410 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020411
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020412 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020413 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020414
20415 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20416 and processed the connection.
20417
20418 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20419 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20420 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20421
20422 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20423 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20424 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20425 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20426 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20427 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20428
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020429 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20430 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20431 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020432 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020433 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20434 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020435 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020436 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020437
20438 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20439 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020440 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020441
20442 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20443 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020444 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20445 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020446
20447 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20448 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20449 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20450 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20451 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020452 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20453 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020455 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020456 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20457 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20458 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20459 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20460 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20461 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020462 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020463
20464 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020465 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20466 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020467
20468 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20469 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020470 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020471 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20472 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20473 overflowing.
20474
20475 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20476 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20477 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20478 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20479 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20480 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20481 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20482 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20483
20484 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20485 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20486 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20487 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20488 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20489 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20490 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20491 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20492
20493 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20494 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20495 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20496 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20497 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20498 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20499 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20500
20501 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020502 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020503 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20504 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20505 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020506 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020507 system.
20508
20509 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20510 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20511 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20512 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20513 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20514 caused by a denial of service attack.
20515
20516 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20517 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20518 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20519 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20520 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20521 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20522 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20523 denial of service attack.
20524
20525 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20526 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20527 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20528 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20529 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20530 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20531 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20532 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20533 processed than on other servers.
20534
20535 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20536 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20537 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20538 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020539 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020540 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20541 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20542 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20543 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20544 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20545 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20546 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20547 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20548
20549 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20550 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20551 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20552 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20553 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20554 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020555 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020556 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20557
20558 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20559 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20560 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20561 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20562 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20563 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020564 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020565 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20566 occurs.
20567
20568 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20569 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20570 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20571 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20572 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20573 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20574 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20575 cookies" below for more details.
20576
20577 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20578 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20579 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20580 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20581 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20582 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20583 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20584 and cookies" below for more details.
20585
20586 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20587 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20588 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20589 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20590 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20591 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20592 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20593 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20594
20595
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205968.2.4. Custom log format
20597------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020598
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020599The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020600mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020602HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020603Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20604separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20605prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20606
20607Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20608variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020609("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020610
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020611If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020612as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020613less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20614the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20615
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020616Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20617"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20618delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20619preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020620
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020621Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20622'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20623https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20624such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20625
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020626Flags are :
20627 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020628 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020629 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20630 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020631
20632 Example:
20633
20634 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20635 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20636
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020637 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20638
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020639At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20640
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020641 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20642 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020643
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020644the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020645
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020646 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20647 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20648 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020649
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020650and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20651
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020652 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20653 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020654
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020655Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20656
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020657 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020658 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020659 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20660 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20661 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020662 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20663 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20664 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020665 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020666 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020667 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020668 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020669 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020670 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20671 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020672 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020673 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020674 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020675 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020676 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020677 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020678 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020679 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20680 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20681 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20682 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20683 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020684 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020685 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020686 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020687 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020688 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020689 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20690 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020691 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20692 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20693 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020694 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020695 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20696 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020697 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020698 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20699 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20700 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020701 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020702 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020703 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20704 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20705 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20706 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020707 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020708 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020709 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020710 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020711 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020712 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020713 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20714 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20715 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020716 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020717 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20718 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020719 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020720 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20721 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020722 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020723 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020724 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020725 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020726
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020727 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020728
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020729
207308.2.5. Error log format
20731-----------------------
20732
20733When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020734protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020735By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20736"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020737will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020738logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20739
20740The format looks like this :
20741
20742 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20743 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20744 Connection error during SSL handshake
20745
20746 Field Format Extract from the example above
20747 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20748 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20749 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20750 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20751 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20752
20753These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20754failures.
20755
20756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207578.3. Advanced logging options
20758-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020759
20760Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20761just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20762options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20763for more information about their usage.
20764
20765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207668.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20767------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020768
20769It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020770HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020771commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20772monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20773ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20774
20775 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20776 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20777 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20778 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20779
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020780 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20781 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020782
20783 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20784 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20785 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20786
20787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207888.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20789----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020790
20791The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20792what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20793or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020794"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020795just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20796log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20797after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20798is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20799with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20800with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20801
20802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208038.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20804------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020805
20806Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20807for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20808"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20809retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20810raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20811a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20812file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20813you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20814"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20815
20816
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208178.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20818--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020819
20820Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20821multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20822them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20823"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20824logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20825error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20826and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20827too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20828useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20829alternative.
20830
20831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208328.4. Timing events
20833------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020834
20835Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20836reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20837the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20838frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020839mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20840addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20841
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020842Timings events in HTTP mode:
20843
20844 first request 2nd request
20845 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20846 t tr t tr ...
20847 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20848 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20849 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20850 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020851 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020852 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20853
20854Timings events in TCP mode:
20855
20856 TCP session
20857 |<----------------->|
20858 t t
20859 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20860 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20861 |<------ Tt ------->|
20862
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020863 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020864 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020865 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20866 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20867 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020868 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020869 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20870 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20871 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20872 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020873
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020874 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20875 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20876 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020877 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20878 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20879 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20880 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20881 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20882 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020883
20884 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20885 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20886 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20887 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20888 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20889 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20890 request typed by hand during a test.
20891
20892 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20893 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020894 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020895 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20896 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20897 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20898 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020899
20900 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20901 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20902 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20903 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20904 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20905
20906 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20907 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20908 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20909 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20910 connection never established.
20911
20912 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20913 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20914 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20915 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20916 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20917 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20918 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20919 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20920 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20921 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20922 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20923
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020924 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20925 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20926 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20927 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20928 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20929 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20930
20931 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20932
20933 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20934 "Ta" can never be negative.
20935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20937 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020938 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20939 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020940 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020942 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020943
20944 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020945 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20946 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020947
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020948 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20949 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20950 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20951 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20952 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20953 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20954 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20955 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020957These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20958protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20959that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020960due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20961"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20962that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020963
20964Most common cases :
20965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020966 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20967 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20968 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20969 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20970 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020971 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020972 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20973 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20974 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20975 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20976 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020977 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020978
20979 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20980 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20981 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20982 of ms on remote networks.
20983
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020984 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20985 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20986 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020987
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020988 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20989 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020990 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020991 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20992 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20993 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20994 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20995 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20996 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020997
20998Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021000 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021001 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021002 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021003
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021004 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021005 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21006 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21007
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021008 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021009 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21010 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21011 flags.
21012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021013 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21014 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021015 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21016 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21017 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21018 the client connection was maintained open.
21019
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021020 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021021 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021022 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021023 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21024
21025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210268.5. Session state at disconnection
21027-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021028
21029TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21030"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210312-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21032each of which has a special meaning :
21033
21034 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21035 session to terminate :
21036
21037 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21038
21039 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21040 server explicitly refused it.
21041
21042 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21043 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21044 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21045 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021046 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021047
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021048 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021049 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021050
21051 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21052 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21053 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21054 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21055 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21056
21057 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21058 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21059 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21060 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21061 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21062
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021063 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021064 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21065
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021066 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021067 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21068 backup connections when going up.
21069
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021070 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021071
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021072 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21073 send or receive data.
21074
21075 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21076 send or receive data.
21077
21078 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21079 with nothing left in the buffers.
21080
21081 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21082
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021083 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21085
21086 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21087 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21088 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21089 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21090 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21091
21092 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21093 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21094
21095 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21096 server (HTTP only).
21097
21098 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21099
21100 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21101 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21102 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21103
21104 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21105 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21106 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21107
21108 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21109
21110 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21111 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21112
21113 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21114 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21115 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21116
21117 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21118 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021119 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21120 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021121
21122 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21123 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21124 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21125 another server.
21126
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021127 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021128 server.
21129
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021130 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21131 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21132 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21133 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21134
21135 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21136 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21137 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21138 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21139
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021140 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21141 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21142 "use-server" rule).
21143
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021144 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21145
21146 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21147 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21148
21149 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21150
21151 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21152 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21153 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21154
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021155 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21156 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021157 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021158 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21159 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021161 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21162
21163 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21164 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21165
21166 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21167
21168 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21169
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021170The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21171was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021172helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21173starvation, attacks, etc...
21174
21175The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21176alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21177easier finding and understanding.
21178
21179 Flags Reason
21180
21181 -- Normal termination.
21182
21183 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021184 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21185 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021186 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21187
21188 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21189 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021190 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21191 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021192 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21193 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021194
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021195 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21196 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021197 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021198
21199 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21200 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21201 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21202
21203 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21204 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21205 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21206 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21207 the server takes too long to respond.
21208
21209 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21210 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21211 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21212 long a time to respond.
21213
21214 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21215 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21216 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021217 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021218 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21219 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021220
21221 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21222 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21223 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21224 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21225 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021226 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021227 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21228 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21229 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21230 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21231 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21232 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21233 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21234 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021235 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021236 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21237 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21238 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021239
21240 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21241 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021242 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21243 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21244 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21245 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021247 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021248 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21249
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021250 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021251 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21252 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021253 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021254 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21255 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21256
21257 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21258 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21259 503 or 504 here.
21260
21261 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021262 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21264 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21265 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21266
21267 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21268 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021269 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021270 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021271 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021272
21273 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21274 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21275 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21276 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21277 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21278 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021279 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021280
21281 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21282 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21283 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21284 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21285 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21286 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21287 solution is to fix the application.
21288
21289 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21290 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21291 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21292 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21293 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21294 external attacks.
21295
21296 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021297 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021298 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021299 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21300 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21301
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021302 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21303 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21304 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021305 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021306 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021307
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021308 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21309 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21310 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21311 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021312 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21313 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21314 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21315 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021316 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21317 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21318 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21319 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021320
21321 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21322 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21323 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021324 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21325 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21326 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21327 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021328
21329 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21330 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21331 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21332 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21333
21334 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21335 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21336 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21337 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21338
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021339The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021340persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021341important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21342re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21343
21344 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21345
21346 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21347 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21348 set on a GET request.
21349
21350 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21351 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021352 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021353 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21354
21355 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21356 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21357 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21358
21359 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21360 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21361 already got a cookie.
21362
21363 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21364 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21365 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21366 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21367 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21368
21369 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21370 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21371 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21372
21373 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21374 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21375 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21376
21377 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21378 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21379
21380 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21381 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21382 then advertised in the response.
21383
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021384
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213858.6. Non-printable characters
21386-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021387
21388In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21389consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21390converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21391prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21392being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21393escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21394is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21395'}' when logging headers.
21396
21397Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21398issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21399containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21400
21401Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21402the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21403performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21404
21405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214068.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21407---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021408
21409Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21410achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021411section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021412cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21413the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21414the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021415locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021416not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21417user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21418a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21419wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21420
21421 Examples :
21422 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21423 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21424
21425 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21426 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21427
21428
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214298.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21430---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021431
21432Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21433proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21434the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21435server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21436
21437Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21438response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021439section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021440
21441It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021442time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21443appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021444are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21445and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21446follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21447request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21448in the logs.
21449
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021450As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21451frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21452an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21453
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021454 Example :
21455 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21456 listen proxy-out
21457 mode http
21458 option httplog
21459 option logasap
21460 log global
21461 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21462
21463 # log the name of the virtual server
21464 capture request header Host len 20
21465
21466 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21467 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21468
21469 # log the beginning of the referrer
21470 capture request header Referer len 20
21471
21472 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21473 capture response header Server len 20
21474
21475 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21476 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21477
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021478 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021479 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21480
21481 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21482 capture response header Via len 20
21483
21484 # log the URL location during a redirection
21485 capture response header Location len 20
21486
21487 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21488 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21489 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21490 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21491 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21492
21493 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21494 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21495 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21496 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021497 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021498
21499 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21500 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21501 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21502 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21503 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021504 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021505
21506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215078.9. Examples of logs
21508---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021509
21510These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21511them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21512reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21513
21514 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21515 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21516 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21517
21518 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21519 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21520
21521 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21522 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21523 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21524
21525 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21526 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21527
21528 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21529 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21530 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21531
21532 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021533 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021534 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21535 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21536
21537 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21538 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21539 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21540
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021541 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21542 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21543 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21544 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021545 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021546 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021547
21548 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021549 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021550
21551 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21552 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21553 Nothing was sent to any server.
21554
21555 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21556 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21557
21558 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21559 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021560 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021561 send a 408 return code to the client.
21562
21563 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21564 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21565
21566 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21567 5 seconds ("c----").
21568
21569 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21570 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021571 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021572
21573 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021574 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021575 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21576 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21577 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21578 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21579 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021580
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021581
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215829. Supported filters
21583--------------------
21584
21585Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21586accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21587unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21588
21589See also : "filter"
21590
215919.1. Trace
21592----------
21593
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021594filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021595
21596 Arguments:
21597 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21598 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21599
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021600 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021601
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021602 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021603 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21604 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21605 amount of the parsed data.
21606
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021607 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021608
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021609This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21610callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21611information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21612filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21613
21614Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21615tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21616a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21617
21618
216199.2. HTTP compression
21620---------------------
21621
21622filter compression
21623
21624The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21625keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021626when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21627fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21628done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21629explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21630filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21631listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21632order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021633
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021634See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21635 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021636
21637
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216389.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21639--------------------------------------------
21640
21641filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21642
21643 Arguments :
21644
21645 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21646 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21647 parsed.
21648
21649 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21650 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21651 part must be placed in its own scope.
21652
21653The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21654external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021655streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021656exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21657also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21658
21659SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21660the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21661
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021662For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021663"doc/SPOE.txt".
21664
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216659.4. Cache
21666----------
21667
21668filter cache <name>
21669
21670 Arguments :
21671
21672 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21673
21674The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21675"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021676cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021677other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21678case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21679is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21680filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021681listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21682order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021683
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021684See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21685 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21686
21687
216889.5. Fcgi-app
21689-------------
21690
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021691filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021692
21693 Arguments :
21694
21695 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21696
21697The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21698request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21699reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21700used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21701implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21702used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21703fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21704used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21705order.
21706
21707See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21708 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21709
21710
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217119.6. OpenTracing
21712----------------
21713
21714The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21715HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21716of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21717Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21718
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021719This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021720
21721The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21722HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21723participates in the work of HAProxy.
21724
21725filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21726
21727 Arguments :
21728
21729 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21730 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21731 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21732 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21733 OpenTracing filters.
21734
21735 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21736 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21737 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21738 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21739 filter must have its own scope defined.
21740
21741More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021742of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021743
21744
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002174510. FastCGI applications
21746-------------------------
21747
21748HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21749feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21750the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21751FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21752servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21753FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21754backend.
21755
21756HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21757application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21758connection.
21759
2176010.1. Setup
21761-----------
21762
2176310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21764--------------------------
21765
21766fcgi-app <name>
21767 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21768 document root must be defined.
21769
21770acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21771 Declare or complete an access list.
21772
21773 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21774 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21775 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21776 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21777 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21778
21779docroot <path>
21780 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21781 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21782 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21783
21784index <script-name>
21785 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21786 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21787 is an optional setting.
21788
21789 Example :
21790 index index.php
21791
21792log-stderr global
21793log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021794 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021795 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21796
21797 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21798 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21799
21800pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21801 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21802 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21803 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21804
21805 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21806 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21807 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21808 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21809
21810 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21811 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21812
21813path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021814 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021815 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21816 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21817 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21818 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21819 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21820 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21821 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021822
21823 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021824 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021825 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21826 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21827 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21828 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021829
21830 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021831 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21832 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021833
21834option get-values
21835no option get-values
21836 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21837
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021838 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021839 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21840
21841 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21842 application will accept.
21843
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021844 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21845 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021846
21847 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021848 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021849 option is disabled.
21850
21851 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21852 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21853 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21854 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21855 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21856 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21857
21858option keep-conn
21859no option keep-conn
21860 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21861 sending a response.
21862
21863 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21864 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21865
21866option max-reqs <reqs>
21867 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21868 accept.
21869
21870 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21871 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21872 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21873 to 1.
21874
21875option mpxs-conns
21876no option mpxs-conns
21877 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21878
21879 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21880 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21881
21882set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21883 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21884 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21885 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21886 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21887
21888 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21889 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21890 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21891
21892 Example :
21893 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21894 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21895
21896 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21897
21898
2189910.1.2. Proxy section
21900---------------------
21901
21902use-fcgi-app <name>
21903 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21904
21905 Arguments :
21906 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21907
21908 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21909 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21910 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21911 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21912 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21913
21914 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21915 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21916 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21917 application are evaluated.
21918
21919
2192010.1.3. Example
21921---------------
21922
21923 frontend front-http
21924 mode http
21925 bind *:80
21926 bind *:
21927
21928 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21929 default_backend back-static
21930
21931 backend back-static
21932 mode http
21933 server www A.B.C.D:80
21934
21935 backend back-dynamic
21936 mode http
21937 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21938 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21939
21940 fcgi-app php-fpm
21941 log-stderr global
21942 option keep-conn
21943
21944 docroot /var/www/my-app
21945 index index.php
21946 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21947
21948
2194910.2. Default parameters
21950------------------------
21951
21952A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21953the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021954script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021955applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21956
21957 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21958 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21959 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21960 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21961 | | |
21962 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21963 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21964 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21965 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21966 | | application. |
21967 | | |
21968 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21969 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21970 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21971 | | |
21972 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21973 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21974 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21975 | | the application's configuration. |
21976 | | |
21977 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21978 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21979 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21980 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21981 | | |
21982 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21983 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21984 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21985 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21986 | | be defined. |
21987 | | |
21988 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21989 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21990 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21991 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21992 | | is not set too. |
21993 | | |
21994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21995 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21996 | | set. |
21997 | | |
21998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21999 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22000 | | the request. |
22001 | | |
22002 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22003 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22004 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22005 | | |
22006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22007 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22008 | | script to process the request. |
22009 | | |
22010 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22011 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22012 | | |
22013 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22014 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22015 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22016 | | |
22017 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22018 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22019 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22020 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22021 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22022 | | |
22023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22024 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22025 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22026 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22027 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22028 | | side. |
22029 | | |
22030 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22031 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22032 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22033 | | connected to. |
22034 | | |
22035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22036 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22037 | | |
22038 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022039 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22040 | | current HAProxy version. |
22041 | | |
22042 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022043 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22044 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22045 | | |
22046 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22047
22048
2204910.3. Limitations
22050------------------
22051
22052The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22053way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22054during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22055establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22056application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22057or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22058message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22059these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22060and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22061
22062Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22063request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22064requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22065
22066About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22067into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22068fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22069"http-request" ones.
22070
22071Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22072FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22073processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22074must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22075here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022076
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022077
2207811. Address formats
22079-------------------
22080
22081Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22082address.
22083
22084This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22085The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22086of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22087equivalent is '::'.
22088
22089Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22090is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22091
22092This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22093family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22094
22095Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22096configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22097use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22098'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22099
22100Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22101socket type and the transport method.
22102
22103
2210411.1 Address family prefixes
22105----------------------------
22106
22107'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22108
22109'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22110 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22111 listening.
22112
22113'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22114 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22115 on the statement using this address, a port or
22116 a port range may or must be specified.
22117
22118'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22119 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22120 using this address, a port or a port range
22121 may or must be specified.
22122
22123'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22124 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22125 using this address, a port or a port range
22126 may or must be specified.
22127
22128'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22129 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22130 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22131 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22132 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22133 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22134
22135'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22136 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22137 start by slash '/'.
22138
22139
2214011.2 Socket type prefixes
22141-------------------------
22142
22143Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22144type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22145this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22146This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22147but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22148
22149Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22150instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22151
22152If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22153they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22154report this to the maintainers.
22155
22156'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22157 to "stream"
22158
22159'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22160 to "datagram".
22161
22162
2216311.3 Protocol prefixes
22164----------------------
22165
22166'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22167 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22168 socket type and transport method is forced to
22169 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22170 this address, a port or a port range can or
22171 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22172 of 'stream+ip@'.
22173
22174'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22175 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22176 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22177 statement using this address, a port or port
22178 range can or must be specified.
22179 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22180
22181'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22182 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22183 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22184 statement using this address, a port or port
22185 range can or must be specified.
22186 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22187
22188'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22189 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22190 socket type and transport method is forced to
22191 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22192 this address, a port or a port range can or
22193 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22194 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22195
22196'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22197 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22198 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22199 the statement using this address, a port or
22200 port range can or must be specified.
22201 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22202
22203'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22204 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22205 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22206 the statement using this address, a port or
22207 port range can or must be specified.
22208 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22209
22210'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22211 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22212 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22213
22214'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22215 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22216 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22217
22218In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22219QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22220
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022221/*
22222 * Local variables:
22223 * fill-column: 79
22224 * End:
22225 */